This content was uploaded by our users and we assume good faith they have the permission to share this book. If you own the copyright to this book and it is wrongfully on our website, we offer a simple DMCA procedure to remove your content from our site. Start by pressing the button below!
.
For
any
two
label
tokens
there
is
a
label
mhich.
is
their
concatenation. AXIOM
1.3
C
^ -1 Cr 5: p )
A label is
not
token
ecfuiform
AXIOM
i^ich
is
with, any
/s -1 Cr S; q>.
a concatenation of
of
tvo
tokens
them.
1.4
c
^ c C r , s , w > / \ p ^ r ^ < f ^ s * t . p , q , r '^'^ '^'^' -• /s TC<j> /s CCp,q,r> ^ T C r » . •• | r | The than ^ | r | - «* - C , ^ r e X). % t < q > . " a, s ** s,r 0 " » , . r. // s ^ Cp — <j • • r » s ) . c * • • s , r . . . P2'-'Pn'^^ P2'P^^> .«> c' ^ F e )?> =• 5? £ X, i s a t h e s i s i n TLTp. •» p,<j s Theorem Axiom * 4« s >. >. If a n d c o n s i d e r Cl.l> ^ C ^ p^ , ^ c " t *( t ). It. . By D e f i n i t i o n IV.29, a s s u m p t i o n C3) r e s u l t s C6> a n d C5> w e s s
Concatenations second
label
of
elements
two
pairs
which
are
of
label
tokens
pairwise
^ xi.
with
eQuiform
first
are
and eQuiform
labels. AXIOM
1.5
CCp,9,s) ^ c<.s,r,t> // a
label
token
concatenation label of
of
token
labels AXIOM
is
lajbel
u is tf and
t
^ CC
tokens
p and
a concatenation r,
then
the
// one
and
concatenation
the of
concatenation only
label
label t and
a label
p and
which
token a
u cere
r.
is
a
and
a
concatenation eifuiform.
1.6
cCp,q,0 ^ cCr,s,f>
and
of lcU>els
of
of if
q and
•* Cp % 2- «* q % s).
same
label
labels
p
and
q
and
s,
then
labels s are
r
token
equiform.
is,
on
and, p and
the
on r
one the
are
hand,
a
other,
a
equiform
if
8
CHAPTER I AXIOM
1.7
cCp,Q,r) <^ s % r 1* cCp,Q,s>. A lotbel
idhicA
concatenation IabeIs
cCp,
it
two
labels
with is
a
lab^l
also
token
tii/iich.
a concatenation
is
of
a
those
1.8
^ cCr,s,u'>
^ t %w-»pS;rv-^
two ecfxiiform
label
of
etfaiform
•
AXIOM
and
of
is
tokens r are
with
e(fui/orm
other
The
explanation
s e e m s , be l e f t
are
elements
or
and of
several
tokens
first
the
example
label
at
of
one
label
the
without
CCp,v,i->>.
concatenations
p and r,
least
some
CcCr,v,p> v
of
of
respectively,
them
is
of
then
a
p
concatenation
token.
ii^t-uitlve
sense
of
these
axioms
a commentao^y. We s h a l l g i v e
theorems
pairs
that
follow
from
the
can,
by way o f
axioms
adopted
above. Axioms 1.3 aind I.la y i e l d i m m e d i a t e l y CONCLUSION
I.l
-> ^ C<:p.q»/>> ^ "* q cCq(,p,p>. No token
label
is
a concatenation
nor a concatenation
This labels
conclusion is
theories which the
token
not of
lets
assumed
formal
Conclusion
analyses
of
I.l
carried
some
us
note
in
TLTk,
languages. follows, out
of label
itself token
that
the
unlike
in
The a d o p t i o n has
in t h i s
no
and and
the of
but
case Axiom
of.
empty
of
most
1.3,
from
importance is
label
itself.
existence
essential
chapter,
some
in
for
agreement
THE AXIOMATIC THEORY TLTk OF LABEL TOKENS
with
int.uit.lon
and
is
useful
syntactically categopial THEOREM
9
for
reflections
token
concatenation
u
labels
this
labels under
% r ,
WlicAi is
of
To p r o v e
hence,
theory
of
I.l
A label
the
the
languages.
C
for
on
and
r
and s
the
a concatenation
mttich
theorem
are
it
there
by
is of
of
equiform
suffices
assumption
further,
CCr,s,'u>.
to
a label
two
with note r
labels
a
by Axiom
1.2
them^ that
such
that
this
theorem
and
1.7,
cCr,s,-u),
which
Axiom
is
by
c C r , s , r '>, Axiom
was
1.4,
to
be
demonstrated. Axioms 1.6 and 1.7 y i e l d CONCLUSION
1.2
cCp,<j, t> /s CCr,s,«> /N t % « ^ C p % r * * q S ; s>. If
eQuiform
label are
tokens equiform
label
toAtens
p and
Q and
if
only
and
r if
are
and
concatenations s,
of
respectively,
q and s are
then
pairs
of
p and
T
equiform.
We shall now record one more theorem, to be used further in the text. THEOREM
1.2
cCp,<j, O
yN C
*u*»piferA<j5:sv
v V
if
tokeTts
which
are
concatenations
p and
q and
r and
s,
either
the
first
elements
respectively, of
of are
those
pairs
of
equiform
pairs,
i.e.
label if
,
p
and and
10
r,
CHAPTER I
are
and
eqrtiform
s,
are
i.e.,
eifuiform,
p or
label,
and. the
r.
is
xithile
respec
remaining
Annex.
In
a
one of
element
of
of
those
of
the
the
pairs, first
other
the
pair,
of
that
i.e.
.
q
elements,
and
a
certain
i.e.,
s
label
or
Q,
and
the
s.
difficult,
that,
least
concatenation
rather
at
second
is
label
The
or
elements
a concatenation
the
t ively,
second
proof
proof use
of
is
t.hls
made
theorem
of
Is
Axioms
given
in
the
1.3,
1.5,
1.6,
I.l,
a n d 1.8.
S e c . 1.4.
Vocabulary
The vocabulary the It
point is
of
the
departure
postulated
t h e following AXIOM
V -
about
last
in
primitive
the
that
concept
description
set
that
it
of
a
satisfies
of given
TLTk
-
is
language.
in
particular
of
all
axioms:
1.9
0 ^ K S L6. The vocabulary
is
a non-empty
subset
of
the
set
label
tokens. AXIOM
1.10
p^V/^q^p^q^V. A
label
vocabulary The alphabet
uift.ic/i is
is
also
included
vocabulao^y or
equiform
of set
with in
formal of
letters
the
a
label
inc luded
in
the
vocabulary.
languages Csee,
is e.g.,
also
often
called
A.A.Markov
11954],
THE AXIOMATIC THEORY TLTk OF LABEL TOKENS
H
M.Gross, A.Lentin [19673, J.E.Hopcroft., J.Ullman [1969J>. Elements
of
the
vocabiilary
are
Simple w o r d s cannot, h a v e a s p a r t s mereology) words t h a t used
to
form,
expressions as
such
as
of
are
a
are
not
simple
Cln t h e
sense
different
their
given
called
On t h e
concatenations
of
tokens.
Le^nlewskl's
f r o m t h e m . Simple w o r d s
concatenations,
language.
vord
of
compound contrary,
any
label
are
words simple
tokens.
and words
This
is
not
be
p r o v i d e d f o r by t h e f o l l o w i n g axiom: AXIOM
1.11
cCp,q,r> ^ r « K. Concatenation The
of
properties
properties
of
two
labels
which
any
is
simple
not
a simple
word
tokens
have
Axiom
1.11
labels. Note
that
«iK>rd.
simple word tokens, but is not true for just any Theorem
1.3 describes
some
properties
of
may is
true
for
label tokens. simple
words
and
confirms the comment made above. THEOREM
1.3
^ c
c
a that
tokens, are
label
token their
then
the
is
first first
a. concatena.tion or and
of
second the
two
elements
second
paiz-s are
elements
of
S.
of
labels
simple
\i)ord
those
pairs
eqxiiform^ Theorem
and 1.11.
1.3 follows
easily from
Theorem
1.2 and
Axioms
I.la
12
CHAPTER I
S e c . 1.5.
Word t . o k e n s
A word given
ianc:ua£;e
vocabulajr-y.
also
need
Those
not.
uord
au^e i n t h e s u p e r s e t of
all
word
definition
be
of
-
Wort; In
course
(oltens
¥ of
tokens
will
s t - r i n g ; i n Ger.
in
be
which
an
we
Fr.
element,
are
a
preceded
secondary
by
a
of
a
of
the
interested
here
t h e v o c a b u l a r y V. The s e t is
mot.>
concept
W in
convention
and
letter
with
the
set
TLTk.
Its
an
auxiliary
definition. C o n v e n t i o n
I.lb.
The
X,
or
without
s u b s c r i p t , i s a v a r i a b l e which r a n g e s o v e r t h e f a m i l y 2 DEFINITION
I.la
XCX> • • K S X ^ A set if
X satisfies
X contains
of
^ <.p,Q e X A C
the
the
sentential
vocabulary
expression
V and
is
closed
\CX> if under
and
the
only relation
concatenation. The d e f i n i t i o n o f V i s a s DEFINITION
follows:
I.l
¥ - n < X 1 \CX> >. The which
fiet
of
all
satisfies
Note
word the
that
-
under Lb
I.la
-
accordance
with
both
of
ail
label
is
expression
Definition
set
tokens
Axiom
definitions which
least
set
of
label
tokens
\CX>.
satisfies
tokens
the
1.9,
Conventions
I.la,b,
the
condition
X.<X>.
¥
the
subset
is
contains
leaist
V and
is
and
Thus
closed
of
in the
under
THE AXIOMATIC THEORY TLTk OF LABEL TOKENS
the
relation
theorems closed
of
on t h e
under
a
13
concatenation least
sets
given
C.
which
relation
This
and
contain Csee,
a
the
well-known
given
e.g.,
set
and
L.Borkowski
are
[19701,
p.222-4> y i e l d C0NCI.US10N
1.3a
y ^ w s Th& set subset
of
of
<3.XX \ooTdL tokens
the
set
CONCLUSION
of
all
Lb.
contains
label
the
a itord
yihich
of
ttto
tooTd. tokens
is
also
contaiTied
in any
set
closed
under
and Lb
Hence
element
I.3C
A
W and
1.11 r
a concatenation
V ^ W^
vocabulary
r
is
¥.
token.
¥ is
an
is
I.3b
CONCLUSION
I.3a.
and
tokens.
p,<j e V A C
vocabulary
of
is
are
cp,q
non-empty
the
set
the
non-empty
such
that
€ X -^ cCp,q,r> ^ r e X) ^ It- £ X.
WW
c(.p,p,r
is
of
label the
sets
tokens
relation under
non-empty, set
W, t h e n
> and
under
irfiic/i contains of
Axiom 1.9 too, under
concatenation. aund
because Axiom
Conclusion
if
an
1.2 t h e r e
is
1.3b
1.4
a.
W ^ 0 ^^ Lb J' 0,
b.
W^V ^ 0.
E l e m e n t s o f It'SK will b e t e r m e d compound
veord
Conclusion is
€ Wsy. T h i s y i e l d s
CONCLUSION
the
tokens.
p
and
Axiom
a
14
CHAPTER I
Two m o r e a x i o m s hold In TLTk. They a r e a x i o m s which
describe
t h e p r o p e r t i e s o f W. AXIOM
1.12
^ ^ ^^ Every word
compo-und
->' p , ^ h , CCp,<,.r>.
\M>rk tohsn
is
a concatenation
We axioms
pair
of
1.13
r e K ^ cCp,q,r> ^ p,q
those
a
tohens.
AXIOM
If
of
a tiK>rd token
is
label
are
tokens
shadl
now
adopted
a concatenat vtord
ion
e W.
of
t\oo label
tokens,
then
tokens.
give
several
t-heorems
above.
Axioms
1.12
and
that, 1.11
follow
and
from
the
Conclusion
I.3b
yield THEOREM
1.4a
A compound tvx> uiord THEOREM
word
token
is
a label
Wiic/i is
simple
word
Theorem
of
tokens. 1.4
r e l t ' + ^ r e K v A label
a concatenation
token or 1.4
is
a laord
a concatenat follows
^ . ^ cCp,Q,r).
token
if
ion
some
of
directly
and
only two
from
if
word
it
is
C o n c l u s i o n 1.3a, Axiom I.ll and T h e o r e m 1.4a y i e l d
a
tokens.
Theorems
C o n c l u s i o n 1.3a.
either
1.4a
auid
THE AXIOMATIC THEORY TLTk OF LABEL TOKENS THEOREM
15
I.4b r e V ^ r ^ y ^ - i
A labol toKen
token
uthich
is
is not
a simple
V
^tord
a concateruxtion
cCp,q,r).
if
oaui only
if
of
any
of
pair
it
is
a word
viord
tokens.
T h e o r e m 1.4a and Axioms 1.10, 1.7 and C o n c l u s i o n 1.3a y i e l d THEOREM
1.5
A label
token
word
wtticfi
is
equiform
with
a word
token
is
also
a
token.
From Axiom 1.13 and C o n c l u s i o n I.3b we obt.aln immediat.ely THEOREM
1.6
C
to is,
token
which
is
a concatenation
a word
token
if
and only
In t h e
proof
of
-theorems of
avail o n e s e l f
of
a certain
as
it
adopt t h e
were,
an
auialogon
if
those
of
labels
TLTk i t
is
metatheorem of
the
two
are
lcU>el
word
somefclmes of
principle
that of
tokens
tokens. convenient
theory,
which
induction.
We
convention
C o n v e n t i o n numbers
e l»0.
are
marked
1.2. with
Theses an
m e t a t h e o r y TLTk, and r e c o r d otir m e t a t h e o r e m
thus:
Caccepted s e n t e n c e s )
asterisk
are
theses
of
whose the
16
CHAPTER I THEOREM
IcLTXguage
of
such
that
TCr)
be
in
it
TCp)
any
free
q
and
and
if
for
respec
^„
r for any
r
Then,
xaord
expression
of
not
a free occur
TCp> by if
any
p and
TCp).
in
P,QGW
P r o o f .
simple
word
q hihich
satisfy
TCcfy.
p
satisfies TCpy TCr),
and then
symbols: •*
A
r-r^r
Assume
Let
and
substitution
satisfies
In
r
it.
the p
a proper
concatenation
p satisfies
of
variable
^ ^ ^ CT
peK
T
p^W
t-hat peV
and
use do
tokens
their
ssntsntial
the
from
p.
tively,
^
a
<j and
obtained
token
TCp)
be
with,
variables
expressions
\eord
TCp)
-recOTdued.
TLTk
of
TC
Lot
I.l .
'^
that
C2>
^ W ^
that
W
be
the
set
of
ail
those
words
which
satisfy
TCpy,
which
contains
is,
C3>
W We
shall
-
< p e
demonstrate
that
W \ T
is
>.
a
set
the
1
vocabulary In
V
fact.,
formula
and
it (3)
is
closed
follows
from
under
the
relation
assumption
CI),
of
concatenation.
Conclusion
1.3a
and
then
the
that
C4>
K c If . 1
On
the
definition
other C3>
of
hand, W
and
if
p,q
formula
e
W
<2>
^
yield
cXp,Q,r>, T<.ry,
where
reW
in
i
accordance r
e
y .
with
This
Conclusion
shows
that
I.3b. V
is
Hence, closed
in
view under
of the
formula relation
C3>, of
THE AXIOMATIC THEORY TLTk OF LABEL TOKENS
'^
c o n c a ' t e n a t . l o n , i.e..
From f o r m u l a s <4> and C5>, u n d e r C o n c l u s i o n I.3c, we o b t a i n W ^ W, which. In a c c o r d a n c e
wit-h <3>, y i e l d s
the
thesis
be
principle
of
the
theorem
being proved. Theorem the
least
the
I.l set
for
This
is
with
the
is
thus
the
set
of
induction
v o c a b u l a r y and i s and
hence
the
closed
for under
principle
of
W.
n-conq>onentlal words; l e n g t h o f word
simple so
of
of
given
by
of
follows
compound initial
their
mereology>, concept
language
which
any
those
determined
the
a
words,
because
use
Lei^niewski's define
the
concatenation,
Compound w o r d s of
the
of
S e c . 1.6.
set
termed
which c o n t a i n s
relation
induction
may
are
from
word
words.
are
finitely
Definition
is
simple
componential
Cin t h e words. word
the
of
W.
exclusively
"structure"
parts
from I.l
recorded
The
component
which
generated
of
words
sense Before
we
refer
of we to
t h e usually adopted convention: C o n v e n t i o n or
without
subscripts,
1.3. L e t t e r s are
variables
Ars<0> o f naturail n u m b e r s w i t h o u t We s h a l l
now
introduce
the
i,
J,
which
k,
I,
m, n,...,
range
over
the
concept
with
the
set
of
the
zero.
definition
of
18
CHAPTER I
set
V of
will
be
they
all
called
are
n—compoTiential
xaord
n-componential
xiiorcl
usually termed
"n-letter
tokens.
Elements of
tokens.
In
that,
formal
words". The s e t
set
languages
V is
defined
by i n d u c t i o n a s f o l l o w s < s e e G.Bryll, S.Miklos [19773): DEFINITION
1.2
a.
*K -
b.
r e
A
"""V «•
ial
We s h a i l
now
definition
\Dord token
c
token is
word
is
a label
token
formulate adopted
n-componentlal
V
word
an n-componential
the
V
one-componential
n-H-component of
V,
and
word t o k e n s .
theorems
and
Their
tohich
a simple
several
aibove
a
describe inductive
simple
word;
is
concatenation
a
word
token.
which
result
the
an
from
properties
proofs
are
of
given
in
t h e Annex. N o t e f i r s t t h a t t h e f o l l o w i n g t h e o r e m holds: THEOREM
Every
1.7
n-componential
word
token
is
a word
token.
Theorem 1.5 has its analogon in THEOREM
1.8
pe A word token
is
token also
which
l^^q%p^<je is
equiform
an n-componential
Two other theorems follow:
with word
K. an
token.
n-componential
word
THE AXIOMATIC THEORY TLTlc OF LABEL TOKENS THEOREM
19
1.9
/N CCp,Q,T> If
a
la&el
m—componential
token one
and
an m*n-componential THEOREM
is
label
is
is
I.IO
then
that
can
It
essential as
replace
shown,
a
word
of
a simple
token
shall
that-
Definition
definition
whether
an
concatenation
of
now
I.2b
from
example,
only
and
an
because,
as
this
n+f-componential an
word
n-componential
formulate
the
theorem
which
theorem. token
word
and
is a
word. refers
to
the
Section.
1.11a
p e V =• V p e n word
In t h e
is
and
token
above,
follows
c o m m e n t made i n t h e i n i t i a l p a r t o f t h i s THEOREM
if
word
s i m p l e word o r a s i m p l e word and a n n - c o m p o n e n t i a l
Every
label
token.
be
We
words.
\ccp,<,,r>.
a cOTtcateruztion
can easily not
**A
an n*1-componential
word
Theorem
obtained
one,
two
vord.
token
n-componential
is
of
1.10
A label that
V.
concatenation
n-componential
'-"''^
if
a
^ r e
token
proof of
of
is
a fini
this
Theorem
tely
componential
theorem
I.l ,
that
V.
we is
avail the
word.
ourselves, principle
by
of
way
of
induction
f o r W. Note fact
that
follows
the from
present
theorem
Definition
I.2a.
is
true Let
us
for
any
now
peK, assume
which "by
20
CHAPTER I
Induction" t h a t
it
is
true
for
word
tokens
p
ami
p
1
that
it
is
true
for
the
word r
which i s
their n
follows
from
the
assumption
that
p
1
e
hence by Theorem 1.9 we have that V j. e I.l
1
and
show
2
concatenation. n
2
V and
p
It
e
2
V,
and
K. By applying; Theorem
we find that the theorem being proved is true for any word
token. Theorems 1.11a and 1.7 yield THEOKEM
1.11
W-
U
V.
k.~1
The
set
component
of
ial
utord
Theorems in
a
I.ll
set
of
a
set
such
affirmative
all
xDord
tokens
is
the
set
of
all
finitely
tokens. arul
I.lla
finitely
have
shown
componential
determined
that
words.
every Is
unambiguously?
word
the
The
token
is
membership
in
answer
in
the
i s p r o v i d e d by
THEOREM I . l i b
p € »•' ^ Vi p e n "^ Every one
set
word of
token
finitely
is
a nnrd
xnhich
componential
V. is
a meitJber
of
precisely
words.
The p r o o f i s g i v e n i n t h e Annex. By
this
theorem
"componentiaiity"
an
other
n-componential
than
n,
and
hence
word
cannot
catfinot
be,
have
e.g.,
an
replaced
by
m - c o m p o n e n t i a l word i f m ^ n. The
rather
clumsy
word
"componentiaiity"
will
be
THE AXIOMATIC THEORY TLTk OF LABEL TOKENS •the
word
commonly uKtrd that
"lengt.h". used
token
p
concept
in
the
will
be
takes
DEFINITION
In
on
21
accordance
literature recorded the
of as
the
symbolism
subject
\p\.
In
the
TLTk
the
most
length
of
definition
a. of
form:
1.3
word
n-componential The
the
following
p € V •» <.\p\ A given
wit-h
token
has
the
^ n *¥ p ^
V).
length
and
n if
only
if
it
is
an
word.
correctness
of
this
definition
is
gU3u:
by
Theorem
I.lib. N o t e t h a t C o n c l u s i o n I.3a, D e f i n i t i o n s 1.3 a n d I.2a y i e l d CONCLUSION
I.5a
p e V ^ p e W ^ A simple Note
u«ord token
further
that
is
a word
Theorem
\p\ token
I.lla
and
«1. of
length
i.
Definitions
I.2a
and
1.3
imply CONCLUSION
I.Sb
p € yr
number
Further, yield
word
token
greater Definition
is than 1.3
a word
token
of
a length
which
is
a
1. and
Theorems
1.5,
I.lla
and
1.8
22
CHAPTER I CONCLUSION
1.6
p ^ W ^ q ^ p ^ A inox-d tuftich. same
length
as
is
)Q| «
a e t j u i / o r n t with
the
\p\.
a given
word
token
has
the
lat(er.
D e f i n i t i o n 1.3 and T h e o r e m s 1.11a, 1.9 and 1.7 y i e l d CONCLUSION
1.7
p,Q e W ^ CCp,Q,r:> ^ \r\ The concatenation the
s'um of
the
lengths
The l e n g t h o f than
zero,
of
two word of
which
follows
\p\
tokens
those
a word t o k e n
-
+
has
\
the
length
etfual
to
words. Is always a natural
from
Definition
1.3,
number
Theorem
I.lib
other and
C o n v e n t i o n 1.3. T h i s amd C o n c l u s i o n 1.7 yield a c c o r d i n g l y CONCLUSION
1.8
p,Q € V ^ C
concatenation
the
length
of
of
two
words
either
of
those
C o n c l u s i o n 1.7 a l s o y i e l d s CONCLUSION
>
has
u/vi'c/i
length
\q\. is
greater
words.
immediately
1.9
p,q Concatenations same
> I P I ..-, \r\
€ W ^ CCp,<|,r> /s CCq,p,t) •» \r\ of
word
tokens
p and
length.
Theorem I.4a and C o n c l u s i o n 1.7 yield
Q and
-
|t|. q and
p have
the
THE AXIOMATIC THEORY TLTk OF LABEL TOKENS CONCLUSION
23
1.10
r e W\V «» ^ V
cc
| p | + |.
p , ^fcPr
i4 compo-und
word, token
fino }))or
of
such,
that
is
that
a word xafiich the
sxun of
is
a concatenation
their
lengths
of
ecfuals
the
word.
We s h a l l a l s o g i v e o n e m o r e t h e o r e m which d e s c r i b e s
words of
a d e f i n i t . e lengt-h > 1. THEOREM
1.12
reW .^ | r | - 7. > 1 • •
^A^
p,^W
^ ' ^ ' " k ^ \
I ^ C
k+lmn A
word
token
of
concatenation
of
each
their
e q u a l s n.
lengths
Sec.
1.7.
Sec.1.6
we
which
states
that
have
But t h e d e f i n i t i o n s to state
word,
pair
word
shall
generalized The
1
word
is
a
tokens
word
such
formulated
a
tokens
finitely
the intuitively
from
make
the
lise
relation expression
are
which
that
obvious
concatenation
of
theorem
formulated fact
i s a word o f
order formally t o w r i t e we
of
>
and t h e o r e m s
f o r n > 1, t h a t
obtained
n
the
is
a
sum of
Generalized concatenation
In
us
length
of
the
term
of
concatenation
c
<-PM>PJ>--,P
C
simple Just ,
words.
s o f a r do n o t allow
that
down t h e t h e o r e m
I.lla>
componential
a length n
CTheorem
an
n-componential
n > 1, i s word
a
label
tokens.
formulated
which
In
above
denotes
the
o f n+2 a r g u m e n t s . +.,»P^
is
read:
p
is
a
24
CHAPTER I
concat.enat.ion tokens
of
n-K
P.>Pj>—>P ^^-
t o be t h e
successive
Oeneraiized
element.s,
The
labels
coinponents
relation
namely
of
of
successive
P^»P_»-..>P ^^
of
that
are
label
then
said
concatenation.
concatenation
c
is
defined
by i n d u c t i o n . DEFINITION
1.4
a.
n " 1 •• Cc
(-P ,p ./>> «• CCp ,p ,p>>,
b.
n > 1 =• Cc"
In
accordance
concatenation "ordinary"
of
with two
this
label
concatenation
n+1-element
which
n-element
Pl'P2'
'^n ^"^ ^ label
only
those
if
p
means
it
of is
Cn>l!)
is
the
two
concatenation
2und
an
tokens of
P^>P^>->P >P ^A i f 1 2 n n+1 is
definition
a
a
two-element
same
as
labels;
p
a
p
is is
label
an
tokens
concatenation
concatenation
an
of
label
of
labels
p^_^^.
And here is the announced THEOREM
p ^ W^
I.13a
\p\
A \jtoTd. token concatenation In
m n+1 ^
of
length
of
certain
accordance
with
possible
to
token
a
is
formulate word
V
which
n*1
is
simple
C
a
label
• itord
Conclusion the is
following a
Cp ,p ,...,p
which
is
^ ,p).
an n+1
-element
tokens.
I.5b,
Theorem
conclusion:
concatenation
of
a
1.13a a
makes
compound
finite
it
word
number
of
THE AXIOMATIC THEORY TLTk OF LABEL TOKENS
25
component.iaI
simple
word
t.okens,
component.ial
simple
words
equals
and t.he
t-he
number
len(;Ch
of
of
the
t>hose
word
in
quest-ion. The p r o o f o f T h e o r e m 1.13a i s c i v e n i n t.he Annex. The f o l l o w i n g t-heorem a l s o h o l d s : THEOKEM
A
1.13b
compound,
coTicatenation The
xaord. of
a finito
simple
Conclusion
tohsn
is n-vmber
implication
I.5b,
a.
Theorem
of
in
by
lemma
induction,
I.13a,
Pi
and
a
certain
tokens. 1.13b
follows
Conclusion
to refer
I.3a.
To
from prove
to
is
a
^ ^ ^ """"^^^Pi'Pz'- 'f>n^'P^ generalization
based
on
that
D e f i n i t i o n I.4a,b, i s l e f t t o t h e Conclusions theorem
word
is
I.l
l
vhich
Theorem
t h e c o n v e r s e implication i t s u f f i c e s LEMMA
lahol
1.3a,
Cnext t o
V o f all w o r d s :
1.5b
Theorems
and
of
-* p
Concliision
conclusion.
'S>f-y. 1.3b.
Its
Axiom
I.ll
proof and
Reader. Theorem
1.4 and I.ll>
1.13a
yield
one
which d e s c r i b e s
the
more set
26
CHAPTER I THEOREM
1.13
A iDord
tok&n
is
either
IS a concatenation
of
a simple
a finite
inord
n'umber
token
of
simple
Simple word t.okens which a r e c o m p o n e n t s word
are,
up
to
equiformity,
or
determined
of
^ c < r , s , t > ^ p,r,
word
which
tokens.
a given
compound
unambiguously.
s o b e c a u s e t h e r e holds a g e n e r a l i z a t i o n o f t h e cXp,q,t>
a label
This
is
theorem
e V ^ p ^ r ^ q S : s ,
which i s a w e a k e n e d f o r m o f T h e o r e m 1.3: THEOREM
1.14
//
one
and
generalized
the
sajne
word
concatenation
tokens, in
the
l < v < n + l fi'^fi
then same
the
of
components
places
are
^ ^ -» l
token
two of
can
be
"r
presented
configurations those
'',• *
of
as
simple
configurations
a word
occurring
ecfuiform.
The p r o o f o f T h e o r e m 1.14 i s g i v e n i n t h e Annex. The
concept
practical later is
to
in be
of
generalized
importance, this
work.
seen
generalizations
in of
being For
our
concatenation useful
in
purposes
has
analyses its
particular
in
certain
theorems
formulated
a
considerable
to
practical theorems for
the
be
found
usefulness which
are
"ordinary"
concatenation. The
following
theorem
is
a
generalization
of
Axiom
1.7;
it
THE AXIOMATIC THEORY TLTk OF LABEL TOKENS
27
ToUows Trom t-hat. axiom and D e f i n i t . i o n I.4a,b. THEOREM
1.15
J4 lab»l
tok&n
concatenation
ufiich
is
n+1
label
of
n-H those
equi/orm
with
tokens
is
a label also
a
token
t/tat
is
concatenation
a of
labels.
Theorem
1.16
is
a
£eneraiizat,ion
of
Theorem
I.l;
it
of
n*1
follows
f r o m t h e l a t t e r and D e f i n i t i o n I.4a,b. THEOREM
1.16
^""'^^^I'^'Z' '''n+l'^' " l < i < n + l
If
a
tokens, labels components
given then which of
The s i m p l e
label it
is are
the
token
is
also
a
pairvnise initial
proofs
'*i ^ Pi
a
^
concatenation
concatenation etfuiform
of with
label
n+f
successive
the
successive
concatenation.
of
Theorems
I.IS
and
1.16
are
left
to
the
Reader. The t w o a b o v e t h e o r e m s y i e l d i m m e d i a t e l y CONCLUSION
n+1 C ^Pt'Pz'
in
accordance
1.11
'Pn*i'Pn^2^
with
» ^ l < i < n + 2 ^i ^ " i
which
if
the
relation
-
of
concatenation
of
28
CHAPTER I
n+2
arguments
holds
holds
between
bet, w e e n
successive
given
labels
with t h e elements of t h e f i r s t
label
which
tokens, are
padrwise
tokens
such
pairwise
that
which any
eqvtiform,
are
of
are
concatenations
thjeir
i-th
To c o n c l u d e
this
g e n e r a l i z a t i o n of
C
section
we
of
pairwise
place,
of
n+1 labels
each
Cl
are
omitted. a
Cq^,^^, ,<J„+i,q>
-
theorem
which
is
a
1.18
etfuiform
two configvirations
same
•* P ^ <*•
C o n c l u s i o n 1.2:
two
^ Qi
components
formulate
^ p * q ^ l < j < n + l ^
If
Pi
etfxiiform.
The e a s y p r o o f o f t h i s t h e o r e m i s
THEOREM
equiform
1.17
Two label are
also
in
-^ l < i < n + l
and
it
concatenation.
Axiom 1.4 h a s i t s i n d u c t i v e g e n e r a l i z a t i o n THEOREM
then
except equiform,
label such for then
tokens that the those
l =• Pj
are all J-th j~th
n*i-element components
fj
*
concatenations occurring
components components
too. The proof of Theorem 1.18 is given in the Annex.
in
Cl<_/
equi
the are form,
THE AXIOMATIC THEORY TLTk OF LABEL TOKENS
S e c . 1.8.
The
29
Methodolosical remarks
t.heory
TLTk,
presented
In
based on t h e s y s t e m o f primitive
preceding;
sections
and
concepts
Lb, %, c , V equivalent
tl981a,1983ail of
t.he
to
tokens
author
and
2dt>stract
words
[19773;
C/9>
like
Lb,
which d i f f e r e d of
label
present
system of primitive
instead
of
by t h e
concrete
S.Nflklos
theory
the
latter
in t h e
papers
amd modelled
on t h e
theory
formulated
theory.
It
by
was
O.Bryll
based
on
and the
concepts %, c , W
f r o m Coi> by h a v i n g
the
outlined
vocabulary
V;
t h e s e t of
the
latter
a l l word t o k e n s W
is
defined
by
the
set
K,
formula CD
r^V^TGWys-i The
length theories.
definitions I p I,
and
Axioms
of the I.1-I.8
V the
following
relation are
c
C
are
identical,
the
identical
too,
and
-1.13 of TLTk a r e replaced by t h e axioms C2>
C4> C5>
0 ;^ K £ If c
y S X ^
^ ^, ^
Lb,
^ r e X^ ^ W S X,
cCp,<j,r) ^ Cr e V ^ p,tt e l»0.
in
Axioms
both 1.9-
30
CHAPTER 1 Thus
t.he
following
t.heorem
THEOREM 1.2 . system.
Cft>
Tho
of
consisting
of
Definition
Ciy
is
P r o o f . Cl>
and
expression
Cl>
theory of
is
from are
based
Axioms
adopt
the
on
set
and
definition I.la>
set
y which
the
other
any
set
-
on
h a n d , If Y which
XCX>,
which
I.9-I.13
of
of
the
are
reX,
from also
directly
from
Definition
CI),
and
finally
expression
C2)
I.3c,
the
Axioms
Axiom
I.ll
the
if in
we TLTk
for
every
<X|\CX».
say
that
and
theory
because
-
C4) ^
in
consisting
s a m e as
because C2>
holds.
then
W S
re¥,
Axiom
system
Condition
the
Theorem
theorem
relK,
to
and
adso
a
and the
Conclusion
hence
In
on
because
I.3a,
if
then
1.1-1.8
Conclusion
X<.Xy t h e
and
concepts, C2>,
the
axiom
of
and
Definition
Axioms
i n TLTk i s
theorems
on
TLTk,
Conditions
Condition
based
Inclusion
the
the system
C2y—CSy,
of
G H <X|XCX», w h i c h i s
primitive
CS>,
I.S,
strength
from
Condition
and
because
directly
from
1.9
\CX>,
axiom
TLTk,
expression
\<X),
the
on
TLTk.
in
In
CD a n d
satisfies
follows
TLTk
system
r
theory
W adopted
the
satisfies
the
converse
C2>-CS>,
of
theory
Theorem
Definition
1.1-1.8
tDefinition
C^>
the
the
I.4b
The
based
expressions
conslstln^^
Axiom
tokens on
contained
Theorem
C3>-C5)
I.l o f
to
that
Is
respectively.
Definition
anot
systems
immediately
expressions 1.6,
first
C2>-C5>
label
concepts,
equivalent
axiom
expressions
follows
tive
of
I. 1-1.8
Not-e
the
theory
primi Axioms
holds:
W
reX
for
satisfies
C5>. baised
On
Axioms on
the
Axiom
1.9
follows
and
1.12
follow
1.13
follows
1.10
follows
Immediately easily
from
THE AXIOMATIC THEORY TLTk OF LABEL TOKENS Condit-ions In
C2> a n d
Definition Theorem
C3>, a n d A x i o m s 1.12, 1.7, a n d
t-he paper
demonstrated
[1983a3
that Cl>
interpreted
the
set
number
1,
the
of
author
label
I.1-I.8,
of
TLTk is
also
in the arithmetic
are
as
Axioms
present,
tokens
<2>-CS>
The theory TLTk is
The consistence
y,
t h e
I.ll.
is
i t was based
on
consistent.
yields
T H E O R E M 1.3 .
interpretation
by
t h e theory
and
1.2 t h u s
31
as the the
set
relation
the function of addition.
set
N of
<1>, the ^5:, as
of
consistent.
immediately natural
natural only
numbers if
numbers
element
identity,
obtained
and
of
the
by
its
Lb and W
without which relation
zero,
Is
the c
as
CHAPTER 11 THE AXIOMATIC S Y S T E M TSCL OF S I M P L E CATEOORIAL
Sec. II.l.
LANGUAGES
The principal o b j e c l l v e s o f t h e c o n s t r u d i o n I h e -theory o f s y n t a c t i c a l l y c a t e g o r i a l
The
discussions
languages,
which
concerned tokens
with
which
languaige expression on
its
is an
do
£,
of to
not
be
in
accordance
grammar
tl935]
Sec.I.l
we
a
which the
consists, vocabulary,
equiformity, meaningful, elements theory
V, V; ^,
the
word
tokens
set
of
all
relation
of
concatenation,
well-formed
presented is
a
imposed
of
characteristic
of
TLTk,
of
K.AJdukiewicz's
conceptions
set
C;e>, e x c e p t
language
those
the in
of
any
C; S >
the
i.e.,
The
sixtuple
of
of
expression
the
successively,
the
operators.
of
be
expression
conditions
Idea
simplified
language in t h e form of t h e < Lb;
of
will
t o his ideas.
gave
CJ?>
the
and
£
by
certain
categorial
chapter,
cat&gorial
by
with
this
bound
simple
languages
simple
language
variables
a
of in
fixed
determined
r e s e c u ^ c h e r s who r e f e r r e d In
but
Include
is
TSCL
constructed
here
tokens,
categorial
theory
arbitrary
called
syntax
the
of
all
tokens,
the
and
expression
label
the
tokens.
tokens,
relation set
of
All
of all the
last
one,
are
described
to
Chap.I.
The
set
S
well-formed
concept
which 32
is
of
all
defined
in
the
be
the
theory
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES TSCL to
and
the
tokens The
adso
<see
categoTial which
theories
may include
of
of
the
because
categorial
S
set
of
used
the
in
expression of
syntactic
connexion
of
expressions
They
are
categories to
carry
of
categories The set
I
o/ -^
o elements
of
functoral,
of
all
I
categorial
are
The
are
are
and
is
auxiliary they
are
in
the
the
syntactic
Secs.II.8
the
S
all
well-formed
Csee
of
of
useful
language
C t CS>
indices
indices.
used
to
The
indices
is
and
syntactic
and enable into
us
syntactic
generated
basic
indicate
remaining
univocally
termed
symbolized language
given
Sees.II.2
a
indicating
cisissif i c a t i o n
basic
syntactically
function
a
both
because
language
in
into
an
of
them.
the
indices
basic
determine
from
the
which
are
categories the
of
derivative,
categories.
Indices
words
logical
of
only
that
given all
expressions
all
expressions.
given
a
correctness,
above
perform
and
by
foundation
concept
III.4>
a
Csee
the
not
the
expression
bound
indices
they
and
of
of
C s e e S e c s . I I . 6 a n d 111.53.
set
I
used
the
out
of
pertaining
introduction
are
essentiaJ
Secs.II.5
checking
III.6>.
the
indices
definition
(see
languages
categorial
is
TSC«»-L,
a n d variables
Although
role
theory
i.e.,
require
languages. their
the
operators
categorial
function,
in
<ji-langvages,
definitions
II.3>,
Ghap,III>
33
by and
that
categorial
the
L. T h e its have
assigned
definite
language
/-unction set
E
of
subset
S
will
indices,
to
that
of
by
word
means
indication
all
is,
selected from
of
of
expression
be
tokens
token from
the
a
of
certain
indices of the
domain
a
and a
given
set of
of the
34
CHAPTER II
function A
t.
cert-ain
put-
synt.act.ic
t-oget.hei>,
concatenation, that and
have is
useful
vocabulary ainalogon (p
4>
the
obvioijs
that
well-formed
not
any
every
greatly
TSCL
language
constructed
in
show
and £, the
that
< Lh;
V, V; •^, C; I
satisfy
is
has
any
its
two
word
which
have
have
this
and
an
<^ ) ^ C<^ >.
to
index, It
way
sentential
definite
the
language
present
Cje >
of
whose
in
be
is is
a
calculus.
conditions
must
words.
requires
which
complex s y s t e m ,
elements
assured, the
to
which
formed
language
categorial
much m o r e
whose
be
indices of
made a b o v e
<(> ,
index
will
p
calculus,
concatenation
the
to
simplified
categorial
and
an
contemporary
operation
that
tokens
calculus,
concatenation
expression
of
is
syntactically
of
has
the
particular
four-element
expression
remarks
is
word
language,
in
t.o
appropriate
that
sentential the
possible
of
the
instance,
brackets,
seven-element
it.
the
token of
of
ip ,4>
by
word
language
tokens
makes
configuration
For
which
the
which
token
language
of
be imposed upon t h e
of
E.
round
well-formedness
The
set
the
word
ordered compound
operation
assigns
assigns
If
the the
an and
three
a
p,
combine
expression
includes
index,
any
into
of
in
hence
finite,
defining
descriptions
an
any
compound
in
tokens
and
indices
a
operat.ion
the
syntactic in
the
characteristic
form
completion. foundation
chapter,
is
of
(JfJ
The of
Is
simple
the
theory
characterized
by
a
namely , 1;
certain
L, p;
E, S; C t C S )
aussumptions
>,
postulated
in
that
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES
35
t-heory. It, any
is
wort/h
noting
ci>-languaee,
form
of
an
to
that
which
ordered
the
the
system
syntactic
theory much
characterization
TSCw-L
more
pertains,
complex
than
of
has
the
CJP >
(see
Sec.III.l). The the
analyses
theory
III.5>
in
cairrled
of
syntactic
two
theorems
of
out
TSCL
which
theory
and
categories
theorems
t/ie
In
of
TSC«»~L c l e a r l y
and
might
syntac
tic
result
by
(see
termed
categories,
refer
to
Secs.n.7, /'undamiental
aibbreviated
as
rttsc. Their
formulation
is based
Cay
on t h e
expression
rCpyq^s,
whose
corresponding
Important The from
definitions
expression
the
by t h e Now
CcO
is
s
by
expression
p.
Co) i s
common
the
has
r,
the s
p, the
r
the
are
its
expressions
schema
of
the
replacement
of
The second
as
II.
has
the
TSC«-L
its
r
its
is
are
fttsc.
One
second
same
syntactic
in
the
form
of
of
the
same
syntactic
theorem
under
y.
implication a y^ y
^
ft
of
q
those
assumption:
the
the
obtained
constituent
of
a ^ ft ^ ftlsc
of
both
implication I.
and
expression
expression
thesis
TSCL
the
assumption
expressions
has
in
theories.
read:
following
are
theorem
Cj'J Thus
in t h o s e
expression
theorems
That
definitions
category.
expression: category.
consideration
has
the
36
CHAPTER II
as
it,s
schema.
Under
the
assumpt.ion
Now Cft^ h a s Cft'i
The
t - h e t w o
its
concretlzatlon
r,s
are
expressions
of
sentences.
fttsc
In t h e
of
the
aa-e
converse
theorems.
expression:
syntactic
category
implications
CIO
a y^ ft' •* r
or dll}
are
a ^
schemata
theory
of
categories requires
of the definitions
syntactic as
of
both
belongs
the
ft'y
C;'>, often
The
expressions
introduction
categories to
of
^
of
categories.
sets
the
Cf
into
Cot) and
syntactic
of
the
of
syntactic
replaceable
In
sentences
of
syntactic
theory
concept
category
in
treatment
the
the
adopted
of
expression
sentences, that
that
is, the
concept of sentence. Including the concept of
the
theory
of
of sentence
syntactic
in the
categories
possibility of defining it. It seems
that
primitive
would
concepts
preclude
It is the
the
defining
of
the concept of sentence that should be one of the fundamental tasks
of
natural definition
the and
theory symbolic
of
sentence
of
syntactic
categories
languages.
It
seems
should
satisfy
the
as also
applied that
condition
to the
which
enables us to formulate the algorithm of checking the syntactic connectedness
of
.^Jdukiewicz. But condition, when
a
expressions, definition
CI'> and
anadogous
of
CIII) are
sentence treated
to which
that
given
satisfies
ais a schema
of
by this the
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES
definition
of
belonging
syntactic
categor-y,
circle.
constructing
In
languages is
we
treated
certain chapter.
try
as
constructed
expression
in
involve
essential
IV.6
we
the
with
the
purpose
DTSCL
and
ideas
in
more
vicious
endeavour and the
next
They
underlie
describing
its
theories
DTSCw-L.
which
same
categorial
TSCL
outlined two
of
a
Our
theory
discuss
the
of
difficulties.
of
the
syntactically
TSCw-L,
languages:
accordance
for
goal
to
danger
of
those
theory
and
the
theory
overcome
the
expressions
of are
TSCL
languages
of
types.
S e c . II.2.
theory.
the
two
the
categorial
TSC«»-L
Now
to
Secs.IV.S
syntactically
and
would
modification, In
of
37
C o n n e c t i o n s b e t w e e n TLTk a n d TSCL
TSCL Hence
substitution,
like
TLTK
all are
is
logical valid
based rules,
on in
classical
logic
and
set
particular
the
rule
of
in TSCL b e c a u s e
TSCL i s
superstructured
o v e r TLTk. Hence a g a i n REMARK II.1.
The c o n s t a n t s y m b o l s o f t h e v o c a b u l a r y o f TLTk Lb,
y,
W, %, C
a r e c o n s t a n t s y m b o l s o f t h e v o c a b u l a r y of
TSCL.
The v a r i a b l e s y m b o l s o f t h e v o c a b u l a r y o f TSCL i n c l u d e C-u i
p, i^ T, s,
t, XI, x>, w i t h o r w i t h o u t
subscripts,
and
X, w i t h o r w i t h o u t and
Cv > r a n g e ,
subscript;
respectively
Csee
Convention
I.la,b>,
over
38
CHAPTER II
Lb a n d t,he f a m i l y 2 The
variables
of
all it.s subset^s.
list-ed
under
1
list,
of
t-he
variable
symbols
of
not
exhaust,
t-he
Z
t-he
vocabulary
of
t-he
language
o f TSCL < s e e Sec.II.S, C o n v e n t i o n I1.3b>. We o b s e r v e t h e p r i n c i p l e Csee C o n v e n t i o n I.2> C o n v e n t i o n whose
numbers
are
II.1.
marked
Those t h e s e s with
an
Caccepted
asterisk
are
m e t a t h e o r y o f TSCL, a n d n o t e c o r r e s p o n d i n g l y THEOREM II.l . a thesis
of
Both tokens. being the
In
shall
both
now
under
theories
it
account.
From
into
ff*, b u t
see
thosis
sentences)
theses
in
the
that
Cacc&pted
sentence)
of
TLTk
is
TSCL.
theories
taken
set
Every
that
also t h e
CSec.II.3,
set
consideration is
Lb that
I of
Theorem
which set
all
II.l),
/
pertain
is we
the
has
out
set
not
indices;
no
word
universal
single
categorial
to
common
only
as
we
elements
w i t h W. Now recorded
/
is with
TSCL, w h i c h
a the
defined use
denotes
of
the
concept a set
new of
in
TSCL.
primitive all
Its
term
basic
definition
is
I , specific
of
indices
CI
includes o
a t leaist one t e c h n i c a l symbol). The
set
/
will
be
defined
with
reference
to
the
set
/
in o
t h e f o l l o w i n g m a n n e r Ccf. D e f i n i t i o n
I.la):
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES
DEFINITION
II.la
XCXy'^ ** I The set and
only
of if
relation
39
Z X ^
label it
of
^
Cp.QS
tokens
incltides
X ^ c
satisfies the
set
the I
expression
and
is
\<Xy
closed
under
if the
concatenation.
Hence we have
II.l
/ - n < X I \ao^ >. The set
of
all
categorial
tokens
tthich
satisfies
By
these
definitions
which
includes
indices
the
/
is
expression
I
is
and
is
/
are
the
\CX>
the
set
of
label
.
least
closed
least
set
of
under
the
label
tokens
relation
of
o concatenation. The three
properties of
the
of
following
described
five
above
axioms
of
all TSCL
by
the
Ccf.
first Axioms
I.9-I.13>: AXIOM
II.l
o The set AXIOM
of
indices
is
non-empty
iTidex.
of
label
tokens.
II.2
p e l A label
set
tnhich
is
etfuiform
y \ q S i p ^ q e I . with
a basic
index
is
also
a
basic
40
CHAFFER II AXIOM
II.3
cCp,q,r> A basic
ind»x
is
not
a
" • r e / .
concatenation
of
any
two
label
a concatenation
of
tokens. AXIOM
II.4
p,
o A categorial a pair
of
AXIOM
index
lahich
categorial
is
not
basic
is
indices.
II.5
r e / /s cCp,<j,r> ^ p,qi € // those
a categorial labels
are
We s h a l l I
of
index also
now
all
is
a concatenation
categorial
introduce
/.
a
n—componential
of
two
labels,
then
indices. definition
by
categorial
induction
indices
of
the
Ccf.
set
Definition
I.2a,b>. DEFINITION a.
*/
II.2 -
/
, o
b.
r e
"**/ • •
V
V
pe I ^ A one-componential n-t-1-component concatenation
ial of
cCp,q,r>. o
categorial categorial
index
index
an n-componential
is
a
is
a
label
categorial
basic token index
index; xahich and
a
an is
a
basic
i ndex. The II.2a,b
syntactic above
respectively,
with. which
analogies
of
Definitions are,
Definitions I.la,
I.l,
successively,
and
II.la,
II.1,
I.2a,b
of
definitions
of
atfid TLTk, the
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES expression
\CX>,
The
same
the
correspondine
those of
a
set,
W
to
the
analogies
appiies
Axioms
observations dv.al
analogon
DEFINITION TLTk
the
which
II.l . next
t-he
set
V,
between
are
self-evident.
Axioms
11.1-11.5
I.9-I.13
of
TLTk.
We
shall
more
precisely
by
making
use
of
of
sxpression
an
/ /
to
and
41
(p
is
of
any
variables
formulate
the
concept
TLTk.
expression
may
and
of
include
the
the
language
symbol
Lb
of
and
the
only
if
symbols <1>
K,
then
the
is
each
expression
4>
obtained place
from
of
¥. is
a
tp f>y
symbols
dual tf*-^
analogon
of
replacement,
Cl> respectively
I . I,
<1>'^
"v.
by
and
the
latter,
in
are
dual
symbols
"l.
o It
is self-evident t h a t
REMARK
II.2.
analoga
of
Axioms
II.1-II.5
Definitions
Definitions are
Il.la,
I.la, dual
II.l,
I.l,
and
and
analoga
II.2a,b
I.2a,b, of
respectively.
Axioms
1.9-1.13,
respectively. N o t e t h a t , b y D e f i n i t i o n II.l*, REMARK
II.3.
Axioms
I.la-c,
I.2-I.8
have
themselves
as
t h e i r dual anadoga. T h e o r e m II.l THEOREM
defini
t ions
a n d R e m a r k s II.3 a n d II.2 y i e l d
II.2 .
The
accepted
in TLTk are
Hence we h a v e
dual
analoga
theses
of
in
all
TSCL. ' '
axioms
and
42
CHAPTER II THEOREM II.3 .
a thesis The
Every dual
analogon
of
a thesis
in TLTk
is
in TSCL. pract-lcal
list., by way of
values example,
of
Theorem
t^hose
II.3
theorems
can of
be
shown
if
we
TSCL which we shall
use in the proof of the theorem given in Sec.II.3 below. We adopt the following convention: C o n v e n t i o n TLTk
has
the
same
II.2.
A duad analogon
number,
but
that
number
of is
a
theorem
marked
of
by
the
semiotics
by
superscript d. Here are the theorems mentioned above: CONCLUSION 1.3
a
I CONCLUSION
o
S I S Lb.
I .4^>
I\I
7t 0 . o
T H E O R E M I.IO
'^ THEOREM
o
1.11
U Ifc-1
Sec.
II.3.
Categorial indices and t h e i r
Categorlal Kazimlerz the
indices
AJduklewicz
hierarchy
of
were
introduced
11934,1935].
semantic
He
into
used
Csyntactlc)
indication
them
categories
in
describing and
in
his
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES investigations
of
the
syntactic
43
connectedness
of
linguistic
expressions. Categorial called
Just
often
been
the
in
that
they
that
do
students
be
TSCL
it
not
describe
axiom
is
kinds.
It
is
to
indices
assume,
are
as
has
label
tokens
are
exhaust,
the
dual
of
analoga
course,
properties
of
the
of
Axioms
I.9-I.13
list
those
aodoms
of
categorial
indices.
The
next
II.6
disjoint
with
Now I
V the
set
of
a.
of
V
of
a
from
(Definition
I.l>
well-formed
expressions.
the
set
the we
/
the
auxiliary
the
well-formed
of
which
is
part
vocaittilary
vocabulary
K)
single a
/
>,
a of
of
X.
language a
of
way
(Definition the
set
relative
Jf.
out
similar
indices
lang-aage
X
is
to
the
indices.
language
expressions of
categorial
object
In
vocabulary
expressions
0.
i t s basic
shall
all
-
a n auxiliary
given
o
given
all
may b e t e r m e d
voc2d}ulary
language
various
convenient
categorial
which
vocabtilary
course,
of
languages
numbers.
is
V n I
from
categorial
II.l, Sec.II.2>.
which
The
of
objects
are natural
earlier,
II.l-II.S,
AXIOM
may
of
Definition
TLTk,
some
purposes
done
Axioms
by
categories,
assumed
For
(cf.
indices,
of
Indexing other
metailanguage
From all
the we II.1>
the
set
word
set can
S
tokens of
all
single
out,
(generated
from
expressions expressions than
It*
£,
relative
indexing are,
namely to
Jf
of
of
a
(see
44
CHAPTER II
Sec.n.4>. The
theorem
announced
In
Sec.II.2
sheds
much
light,
upon
t.he
vith
th»
s»t
of
all
Jf
by
the
a b o v e pemark: THEOREM
II.1
¥ n I m 0. The
sot
of
all
catsgorial
word
tokens
is
disjoint
indices.
The p r o o f I s g i v e n i n t h e Annex. Gat.egoriaI relation
indices
t
of
are
assigned
indicating
relation
Is
satisfies
t h e following axioms:
AXIOM
the
the
second
a
ftmc tion
a subset AXIOM
of
A label
with
the The
we
of
of
Miord
primitive
tokens.
concept
In
That
TSCL.
It
of
one
L is
a fxinc
arg'ument
tion.
which
maps
a subset
of W
I.
II.8 p e
index
words
II.7
L is
an
the
indices
specific
L S Wxl and
into
to
DCL'>
token is
xnhich
also
index
^ < J % p ^ q f € D C i , >
is
ecfuiform
a word
of
that
interpretation
note
that
the
are
words
to
that
word of
/s
L *; <. Cp>.
with
has
an
a word index
token
which
that
is
has
equiform
token. Axiom
elements
of
II.8
the
becomes
domain
comprehensible
DC i. > o f
the
if
function
<7>
L
elements
of
the
which
an
index
counter-domain
has
been
D <(.> o f
assigned,
that
function
while
the
are
the
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES
indices
of
-those
words.
This
foUows
45
iTnmediat.eiy
from
Ajdom
word
tokens
II.7 i n t h e v i e w o f CONCLUSION
Il.l
a.
DCt? = ¥ ,
b.
D'*C0
The domain laftile
its
of
that
arbitrarily assigned
of
is
11.7
whether
to
decide
words o f
a
the
s»t
sxibset
of
and
¥ of of
indices
technical,
a given
whether
Conclusion
categorisd
structural,
all
the
set
I
of
all
do
are usually
Csuch
as
indices
not
or
signs
language
categorial
Il.l
decide
not
are
Included
brackets);
are assigned
in
n o r do
only t o
the
practice
we
£.
Conclusion not
II.la
seems
Inclined
concatenation that,
a stibs&t
Axiom
vocabulary
are
L is
indices.
Note
they
1.
counter-domain
categorial
the
£
of
however,
expressions
to
natural assign
t h e simple
with
also
a
categorial
words
reference
(Ger. AusdrUcke>
of
to those of
because
that
a
given words
language.
in index
to
every
language.
We do
which a r e
termed
Expressions
will
b e d i s c u s s e d i n Sec.II.4. Axioms II.8 and I.lb i m m e d i a t e l y y i e l d CONCLUSION
II.2
a.
p e Ddy
b.
p,q
We
shall
occasions.
e
^ q ^ p •* tf e
DCL^ /\
avail
(f ^ p
^
ourselves
DCty,
i.
of
Conclusion
II.2b
on
many
46
CHAPTER 11
S e c . II.4.
The
Expressions
one-to-one
operation and of
the
forming
last,
all f i n i t e
Oc L > o f to
of
all
them. I t s
funct-ion
p
compotind concept
and g r e a t e r
than
tokens,
variable, tokens
called is
the
t-he third,
of
TSCL. I t s
domain
is
the
sum
one
Cartesian
powers
of
the
set
which
counter-domain
one
expression
primitive
word
of
have
a
categoriaJ
is a subset
of
DCi.^\y.
index
assigned
Hence
we
add
t h e f o l l o w i n g axiom t o TSCL: AXIOM
II.9
p:
U DCL>
»
DCL^W.
*-2
The c o m p o u n d w o r d t o k e n d e n o t e d
which
is
the
value
of
n>\
and
(~p^,p.,.-,p > for O 1 n -domain
of
compoMnd tokens
p,
and
misunderstanding, compoxind To
,
in
an
of
£.
the
compound
expression
will
be
not
precise,
thus
which
set
consisting
order.
If
is
Their g e n e r a l i t y makes precision
the
of
will
be
is
connected
certain
Justified
by
impossible.
no
termed
make
counter-
is
n+1
there
argument
the
DCtJSK, of
intuitions
shall
for
element
the
expression
we
p
Jf,
appropriate <6)
an
of
of
that
such
operation
also
token
expression
activate
is
hence
expression P,^,P.,--,P
the
by
called
<7»>1>
of
briefly
remarks.
their
word
risk
with
a
a
the They
character.
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES
We b e g i n w i l h s e v e r a l
terminological
The s e q u e n c e
tokens
C*> of
o f word
''o'^l' which
the
compound
word
functor <xTgvm»nts that
p
of
of
C6>, of
conventions.
'''n expression
be called t h e e x p a n s i o n The
47
of
expansion
the
p^, t h e
£
Is
constructed
will
<6).
the
and
<<5> o f
(.e^
words
word
p.
will
be
P^iP^r-tP
Cl£i
called
the
be
called
will
-
the
i-tK
n>ai.-n the
argument
of
functor.
By
analogy
functor"
au^d
functor Index
to
of
of
the
commonly
"name-forming
The
functor,
existence
terms
functor"
<6> t h e a-forming
C<5>.
used
of
we
shaill
where
that
"sentence-forming
index
a
call
is
the
the
follows
main
categorial
from
Axioms
II.9 a n d I I . 7 . The
label
treated
as
compound functor
from a
the
translation
expression pu
and
"translation" intuitive
language
Its
is
sense
into of
X
of the
which
successive
left
TSCU
language is
of
arguments we
with
given
that
by
to
by
such
a
the
main
•
The
term
n
assume It
of
be
of
P^rP'^f-tP \ Z
merely
C6> m a y
TSCL
constructed
undefined;
agrees
denoted
that
Alfred
its
Tarskl
i n h i s w e l l - k n o w n m o n o g r a p h [19331. In
the
translation TSCL
does
expression whether
present of
not is
a
a
book
compound depend
recorded;
bracket
the
essential
expression upon In
notation
the
of
X
into
symbolism
particular, is
fact
used
it in
is X
is
that
the
the
language
in
which
independent or
not.
of
that of That
48
CHAPTER II
t
depends
compound
sense
of
merely
expression
Le^nlewski's
on or
which
the
mereology>
words
of
the
expansion
expansion
of
its
part
which
is
a compound
of
(in
the
expression
are main functors and which aire their arguments. For of
instance,
each of
the
the
same
following
metallnj^uistic
label
is
a
translation
synonymous compound expressions
of
the
language of the sentential calculus: p .«
letters
and the
p,q,r
are
expressions
notation
introduced
in
here,
given
which Is now
o-Cp,oCq,r»; of
above
most
[19291,
CpEqr.
course, are
sentential
written
commonly used,
aurad
variables,
successively
Le^niewski's
Lukasiewicz's
in
the
notation
parenthesis-free
notation, called Polish, tl929]. Axiom formulate
II.8
Csee
an
important
same applies t o the AXIOM
If
p
is
a. word
it
if
of
n+1 word
same
II.2b>
property
of
makes compound
it
possible
to
expressions.
The
following
11.10
sv.ccessi'oe
and only
equiform
Conclusion
with
place.
compo-und expression
consisting
tokens,
token
if
it
then is
also
tokens
and
every
the
word of
the
a
label
q
of is
n+1
ecfuiform
a compound expression word
of
expansion
the of
Cn>l^
expansion p occxirring
with
consisting of
cf in
is the
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES
A x i o m 11.10 l e a d s CONCLUSION
49
\,o
II.3
^ Cp %
Tiiio compoxindL expressions \aoTdi tokens their
each,
are
expansions
consisting
equiform
t^ich
if
occ-ur
in
of
and the
the
only
same
p^
same
if
any
place
are
% Q^>.
nvanber
of
terms
of
t\fo
equiform.
The p r o o f i s g i v e n i n t-he Annex. We f o r m u l a ' t e t h r e e f u r t h e r DEFINITION
a.
definitions:
II.3
E
m V n
DCiy,
s b.
£
-
D'*<:p>,
G
c.
£•
E -
U E .
s The tokens
c
elements of
£.
counter-domain
of
the
The of
set
elements the
E
are
called
aa>e of
function
t e r m e d compound e x p r e s s i o n set
E
the p,
tokens
expression
simple
In
accordance
expressions
expressions,
of
of
with £
is
sum
of
of
Jf.
the
earlier
been of
the
Frequently,
when
and E we s h a l l J u s t
refer
II .3c of
i.e.,
The e l e m e n t s
expressions,
Definition the
E , c
expression
already
X.
tofcens
compound
simple
set
have
speaking about t h e elements of E , E to
called
the
the set
and set of
all
expressions. E its
e x p r e s s i o n s and t h e s e t o f a l l i t s compound e x p r e s s i o n s . D e f i n i t i o n 11.3a, Axiom I.IO, and C o n c l u s i o n II.2a yield
of
all
simple
50
CHAPTER n
CONCLUSION II.4a
p G E A label also
token
vihich
a simple
y^
is
ecfuiform
iiiith
a simple
expression
is
Conclusion
II.2a
expression.
Definition
II.3b,
Axioms
11.9
and
11.10
and
yield CONCLUSION II.4b
p G E A label is
also
token
mhich
a compo-und.
is
/\
with
a compo-und
expression
expression.
D e f i n i t i o n II.3c and C o n c l u s i o n s II.4a,b y i e l d CONCLUSION
A label also
II.4C
token
\uh.ich
an expression
of
is
etfui/orm
with,
an expression
of
£
is
X.
D e f i n i t i o n s II.3a,b,c and Axiom II.9 y i e l d CONCLUSION a.
£• c
b.
E
The of
set
all
II.5 S OCL>N^',
S
of
D(.L:>.
all
compound
expressions
is
compound words
included
expressiojxs
which in
have the
set
is an of
included
index. all
The
words
in
the
set
set
of
all
have
an
which
index. In
accordance
with
Conclusion
categorlal index assigned to it.
Il.Sb
every
expression
has
a
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES To want,
conclude t o
Lhe discussion
point,
construction,
t.o a
carried
fragment
t h e fragment
of
which
51
out^ i n
t.his
t h e theory describes
sect.lon
TSCL
y/e
now under
t h e system
of t h e
form: <£ >
< Lb; V, y; 5:, C> Z , I,
c In
L
, p; E >.
o doing
and
so
we
Axioms
the
also The
theory TETk
TSCtr-L,
to
II.l-II.lO
fragment 11.13.
refer
and
is
under
tokens
t h e foundation
analysed
(jm languages,
in
that
definitions
II.la
and
of
TLTk
I1.1-II.3.
That
11.12
and
II.8-II.10,
consideration
will
be
called
t h e
theory
and denoted by TETk.
of
t h e
is
and
Definition
now
expression
axioms
Definitions
includes
fragment of
the
TSCL
next
and also
chapter
languages
with
of
and
pertaining
operators
which
t o bind
variables. TETk the of
most
i s enriched important
by new concepts, of them
o f TSCL.
o f a vtell-formed.
One
of
expression
£.
S e c . II.5.
We
Well-formed
begin
with
many o c c a s i o n s
a.
further
We r e s t r i c t
C-u !) t h e s e t E.
expressions
formulating
C o n v e n t i o n
to
is that
specific
p,<j,r,s,
several
conventions,
t o be used on
in t h e text. II.3 t h erange
of t h e variables
with
o r without
subscripts,
52
CHAPTER II
b.
The
letters
Cv >
a,b,c,
,0,
with or without
subscripts,
3
I.
range over the set c. and
i.
for
any
i
e
i.
ma.,
(.Co.) "ft".,
We e n l a r g e
Convention
with
zero.
Convention concerning
•
d,
the
range
t
of
the
i»J»fc>i »"»>'>»•••> (see
(.<s>
//u<0>
tCp.) d.
(.C<j> " 6 ,
I.3>
II . 3 a
the
to
the
is
set
not
in
variables
tCs.)«d..
variables
with
or
NLKO>
of
without all
naturail
contradiction
of
the
type
subscripts,
with ^'*'^^
numbers
Remarlc Csee
II.1
Sec.II.2>
because CONCLUSION
II.5C
C S V .
The alI
set
word
of
all
expression
tokens
is
included
in
tfie
set
of
tokens.
T h i s f o l l o w s f r o m C o n c l u s i o n s Il.Sb and II.la. The
correctness
of
Convention
11.3c
follows
from
Conventions
II.3a,b and C o n c l u s i o n II.5b. We now -formed
formulate
expression
£.
In
doing
of
the
of
order
set n
so
the tokens
we
avail
S consisting CTI>0>.
definition of
the
a given simple
ourselves of
of
all
of
the
well-formed
set
S of
all
categorial
welllanguage
inductive
definition
expression
tokens
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES DEFINITION
53
II .4
s b.
p e
$
^
p e
S ^
V Po^Pj,
,P„€*5
00
c.
S -
By
Oefinlt,ion
well-formed
U "S. n-0
II.4a
a
expression
well-formed
simple
of
expression
order
token
of
is
£
are
has
with
already an
p satisfies the
c accordance
functor
of
of
index
the
that
or
II.4b
set
is
a
every
of
S, a b o u t which we a
Is
order assume
compound
expression
that
all
its
order
h,
S. F u r t h e r ,
the
such
tokens the
Definition
is
Pr^yPtyP'.'-fP
to
^
of
words
that
is
expression
condition
m in
If
the set
expression
which b e l o n g
By
of
o r d e r fc+1 e i t h e r
defined,
expansion
well-formed
expressions
been
0.
p of
k, and t h u s i s an e l e m e n t o f that
expression
Ca,a^,...,a^,ajj>,
with
p, t h a t a
functor;
which is
the
and t h e in
m
the
categorial
a-forming
indices the
of
index
functor, all
a.
index is
of a
be
main
concatenation
successive
should
the
arguments followed
of
by
a
P definite
technical
AJdukiewicz's
index.
symbolism
f u n c t o r of p, t h a t i s f r a c t i o n a/at.,a.,...,a . \ Z n By D e f i n i t i o n
II.4c,
Note the
the S is
in
categorial
a-forming the
this
sum
connection index
of
Index, h a s t h e of
all
sets
of
that the
form
in main
of
the
well-formed
54
CHAPTER II
expression
tokens
of
a
finit-e
order
Cgreat-er
about-
well-formed
t^han o r
equal
to
tokens
we
zero). Instead
of
speaking
s h a l l h e n c e f o r t h r e f e r Jvist t o w e l l - f o r m e d The
set
following
S
of
we
well-formed
AJdukiewlcz
syntactically Now
all
in
S
can
adopt
be
a
expressions.
expressions
that
connected
expression
respect
-
of
J? we
call
the
shall se t
of
expressions.
defined
otherwise.
successive
To
substantiate
definition,
which
is
this
claim
auxiliary
In
character. DEFINITION
II.S
s
p n>l
p^,p^,
. . . ,p^eX
A, C The set
X satisfies
a superset
of
expansion condi
uhose
tion
We
the
m
is
P
also
give
tfte set
all also the
E words in
Ca,a.,...,a
condi
and
'^
tion
'^ ^O '^l ,a > •* p e
SCXy
if
e.very compo-and are
that
in
*^n
X and
Xi.
and
only
if
expression which
it
is
with
an
satisfies
the
set.
theorem
which
could
replace
the
adopted
definition of S. THEOREM
II.2
S - n < X I 6<X> >. S is The
the
least
proof
ourselves of
is
set given
that in
satisfies the
the
Annex. In
condi that
tion
6CX>.
proof
we
avail
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES LEMMA
II.1
S S
m <: n ^
Jl\e-
set
greater
of
than
expressions The
55
all n
of
lemma
II.4b, '^s S
well-formed
is
expressions
included
order
S.
of
in
the
set
of
from
the
fact.
ca\
order
all
not
-well-fornted
n.
follows
easily
'that.
, by
Definit.ion
S f o r any At.
Definitions
II.4a,
II.3c
and
II.4b,
Concliislon
Il.Sb,
Axiom
II.9 and D e f i n i t i o n s II.3b,c y i e l d by i n d u c t i o n LEMMA
II.2
* S £ £ = D
f r o m which, by D e f i n i t i o n II.4c, we a r r i v e
at
CoNcuusioN II.6a S £ £ /N S S D C O .
The the
set
set
that
of
of
have Let
us
all
all an
veil-formed its
expressions
expressions
and
of
the
set
£ of
is
included
all
its
in words
index. call
the
of
Jf.
expressions
elements
S\ S
of
Definitions
compound
II.4c,a,b,
Lemma
well—formed II.2,
Axiom
II.9, Definition II.3b, and Conclusion 11.5a yield C O N C L U S I O N II.6b
c The subset of
set of
of
all
compound
the
set
of
at I compound
word
all tokens
well-formed its
compound that
have
expressions expressions a categorial
of and
£ the
index.
is
a set
56
CHAPTER II
A t h e o r e m a n a l o g o u s t o C o n c l u s i o n II.4c holds: THEOREM
II.3
An expression expression
is
Theorem
of also
X vittich
is
etfui/orm
a xiiel I-formed
II.3 f o l l o w s
with
its
xaell-formBd
expression.
immediately
from
the
lemma
whose
proof
expression
of
by i n d u c t i o n i s i n t h e Annex: LEMMA
II.3
An expression order
h is
Prom arrive
of
also
X vifiich
is
a vtel I—formed
Conclusions
II .6a
etfuiform
with
expression
and
its
of
II.2b
order
2u^d
Convention
II .3c
we
at
CONCLUSION
II .7
p,q Ecfuiform
eS'Np%<)^a%&.
well-formed
By C o n c l u s i o n
the
set
of
S is
£ Kave of
h a v e a c a t e ^ f o r i a i index. N o t e t h a t we a r r i v e
at
CONCLUSION
II.6a,
expressions
set
Ttie set
of
all
in common with Conclusion and
Axiom II.7.
a
e
indices.
expressions
that
II.8
S n (.CS> -
II.1
h.
Dtel l-formed
the II.8
follows
set is,
from
of as the
0.
expressions
of
£ has
all
the
indices
of
these
it
were,
a
latter.
specification
Conclusions
no
elements expressions.
of
II.6a,
Theorem 11.5c,
and
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES
The s e t , i.<S> m i g h t b e t e r m e d t h e set the
well-formed
Axiom
II.6>.
expressions
57
of
expressions
o f Jf Csee t h e c o m m e n t s
By C o n c l u s i o n
II.8,
n o t included i n t h e e x p r e s s i o n s
the
indexing
that
follow
expressions
o f X. They b e l o n g
of a metalanguage o f t h e o b j e c t language
indexing
to a
are
fragment
£.
In TSCL. we a d o p t o n e m o r e axiom: AXIOM
11.11
o There basic
is
a compotrnd
categorial
Let
us
of
that
the
set
indices
which
are
expressions
to
equiform
sentences
that
is
o r sentential
consideration
of
X which
has
I
of
basic
indices
consists
Axiom
equiform
o f Jf which h a v e
with
that
expressions 11.11
with
letter,
the
letter
a n index are
"s".
assigned
usually
called
o f X. In t h e c a s e now under
postulates
the
existence
of
s e n t e n c e which i s a compound e x p r e s s i o n o f X. Axiom 11.11 l e a d s u s s e l f - e v l d e n t l y
to
CONCLUSION II.9a
S\^S * 0. There
is
a compound
C o n c l u s i o n II.9a y i e l d s
well-formed
expression
of
X.
immediately
CONCLUSION II.9b
S i< 0. The set
a
o
Those well-formed them
expression
index.
say '
exclusively
veil-formed
of all
vtell-formed
expressions
of
X is
non-empty.
a
58
CHAPTER II
Further, sets
S,
where
11.4c,
S
II.9b.
Thus
arrive
should
would
S««0, t h e n ,
Ai > 0, would also
in
be
be
empty,
accordance
Definition
empty,
which
with
too.
would
II.4b,
each
H e n c e , by
II.4a
the
Definition
contradict
Definitions
of
Conclusion
and
II.3a
we
at
CONCLUSION
II.9C
° S - £• m s The s e t that
by
have
of
vords
of
an index,
is
£,
r) y !H 0.
DCL)
that
is
the
set
simple
iiiord
tokens
non-empty.
C o n c l u s i o n s II.9a,b a n d II.6a,b y i e l d t h e CONCLUSION
of
II.9d.
The
sets
DCiy,
successive f)Ci.J>\K,
E,
and
E
are c
non-empty. We shall now adopt definitions of two sets: the set B of basic
expressions
of £
saxd the s*f
F of
all
functors
all
of that
language. DEFINITION
II.6
'^ The
set
of
xoell-formed
that It II/4
set
have
'
o
expressions of
is
£ vthich
have
the
set
a basic
of
all
those
index.
II.7
of an
follows and
basic
expressions
DEFINITION
The
all
II.3
'^ is the
functors index
which
from
the
that
is
not
' set
a basic
definitions
the
index
o well-formed
of
of of
expressions
index. B and a
F and
functor
from is
Axioms
always
a
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES
concatenation whereas
of
the
They
of
are
immediately
least
index
concatenation sets.
Cat
of
indices. also
from
two
-
cf.
a
basic
This
shows
non-empty.
Definition
Theorem
I.
expression that
The
II.6
59
never
B and
Axiom
is
F are
non-emptiness
and
indices,
of
11.11
a
disjoint B
follows
because
we
have CONCLUSION
11,10 CSN^'sJ n
There
is
basic
a compound
S ^
well-formed
0.
expression
of
X which
is
a
expression.
The
non-emptlness
II.9a,
Definitions
of
F
follows
II.4c,a,b,
immediately
Convention
from
Conclusion
II.3b,
Theorem
1.13'^b,
Definitions
II.6
and
II.7,
that
the
sum
and D e f i n i t i o n II.7, It
also
Conclusion
follows I1.6a,
immediately
Axiom
II.7,
from
and
Conclusion
1.3
o f B and F e q u a l s t h e whole s e t S. Hence we h a v e THEOREM
II.4
S - B u f / ^ B i « 0 / N F ^ 0 ^ B n F « i 0 . The
set
of
two
non-empty
and
that Since,
sets
k
of by
0 S \ S,
demonstrated
all and
all
well-formed disjoint
func
on t h e
setst
that
of
of
all
£
is
the
basic
sum
of
expressions
tors.
Conclusion where
expressions
fe
II.9a, >
0,
strength
II.1. T h i s i s why t h e s e t
S\ S is of
Is
non-empty,
non-empty, Definitions
too,
each which
II.4c,b,a
SN S, which i s equal t o t h e
and
set
of can
the be
Lemma
60
CHAPTER II
^ c
Ca,a.,...,a
,a^» >
1
71
O
c a n n o t be e m p t y . Hence t h e r e a
finite
Theorem
Is a p
number
e
of
1.13 b, t h e r e
S such t h a t
indices. Is
a
Hence,
is
by
p e S such
s o t h a t , by D e f i n i t i o n II.7, p
a
that
a concatenation
Definition
II.4c
P^^eS aind a
e
of and
I\I
,
find
a
X;
it
Is a f u n c t o r . This yields 0
CONCLUSION
11.11
^S n F J' 0. There It
in £ a simple
follows
basic
from
expression
follows that
is
Conclusion aunong
uhich
11.10
that
the
compound
Conclusion
II.lt
and
always
a functor
fi'om
we s h a l l
expression
find
is
we
a /unc
shall
always
expressions
Definitions among
the
tor.
of
II.4a
and
elements
of
11.3a the
v o c a b u l a r y o f Jf. The
following
theorems
have
close
connections
with
Theorem
II.3: THEOREM II.5a
peB^Cf^p^qcB. An expression
and
expression is
of also
£
a basic
wttich
is
equi/orm
expression.
with
its
basic
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES THEOREM
Il.Sb
An expression also
61
a f tine
of
£
vttich
is
etfuiform
with
its
functor
is
Theorem
II.3,
tor.
Theorem
II.5a
follows
Conclusion
II.7
and
Deflnlt-loti
n.7.
Theorem
from
Axiom
Definition
II.6,
Theorem
II.5b
II.2;
II.3,
Conclusion
II.7,
follows
from
Theorem
1.4 a,
and Axiom 1.7.
S e c . II.6.
Synlact.ic c a t e g o r i e s
The
concept.
E.Husserl's 11900/013.
syntactic
category
Bedoufungskategorien Husserl
the point of sentence,
of
and
used
interchangeable
CSemantic
distinguished
view o f
his
semantic
s y n t a x , namely t h e
them
originated
with
role
reference
Creplaceable>
to
from
categories)
categories
from
t h e y c a n play i n classes
expressions
of
in
a
mutually sentential
contexts. A similar semantic
intuitive
category
syntactic In
that
of
the
was associated
by S.Le:^niewskl,
categories
C193S1.
sense
course
"syntactic
119291, of
the
A.Tarski
time
the
category"
the
author
of
11933),
and
more
was
with
the
of
theory
of
K.AJdukiewicz
adequate
adopted
concept
term,
by
namely
I.M.Bochetiskl
11949], y.Bar-Hlllel 11930,1964], and c o n t e m p o r a r y l o g i c i a n s . The l a t t e r agrees
with
do n o t its
always u s e
origin.
In
that
term
in t h e
the
present
manner
book,
too,
which when
62
CHAPTER II
formulating usual
t-he
definition
intuitive
sense,
of
which
that is
term,
due
we
to
deviate
certain
from
its
difficulties
in
symbolized
by
d e f i n i n g t h a t t e r m , o u t l i n e d i n Sec.II.1. A syntou:tic Ct
.
We
category
observe
an
Conventions
definition of t h a t DEFINITION
with,
index
^
II.3a-c
will
and
be
adopt
the
following
concept:
II.8
Ct^ - < p I a % ? >. A syntac
tic
category
of
£ whose
expressions The
intuitions
category
defined
with, index
is
connected in this
an
index etfuiform
with
way
f
the
are
is
the
with
f.
concept
explained
by
set
of
of
syntactic
the
those
two
fttac
given in Sec.II.7. Now Ct
will be used to denote the family
categories
of
expressions
of
Jf,
in
of
all
syntac
tic
accordance
with
the
following DEFINITION
II.9
Ct m i ct The is
the
indices By
family
of
family of
of
syntactic
all
expressions
Conclusion
demonstrate
Ct that
agreement.
categories
syntactic of
Il.Pd
that
which d e t e r m i n e s categorial
all
I ? e t<Ey >. of
categories
expressions whose
of
X
indices
are
We
shall
£. the
is
set its
partition The
E
is
logical is
the
definition
of
non-empty. partition.
relation the
The « of
relation
relation syntactic
»
hais
the
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES
following
form:
DEFINITION
11.10
P ^ 9 «• The
63
expression
p >• q i s
y P>9 e Ct .
r e a d : p and
q belong
to
the
saune
c
syntactic In to
category.
accordance
the
same
with
Definition
syntactic
category
11.10
if
two
and only
expressions if
they
belong
belong
to
a
s y n t a c i c c a t e g o r y w i t h a c e r t a i n index. Definitions I.la-c
11.10
aind
II.8,
Conventions
II.3a-c,
and
Axioms
yield
CONCLUSION
11.12
p -<)«<> a % b. T«i» e x p r e s s i o n s belong only
if
they
have
to
t/te same
e
tic
category
if
and
indices.
C o n c l u s i o n 11.12 and Axioms I . l a - c CONCLUSION
syntac
yield
11.13
a.
P ' P'
b.
P '
C
t '^ Q = P. c
c
c.
p » < j ^ c j « r ^ p " r . c
c
The relation symmetric In
of
and
c
syntactic
transilive
accordance
categorial in
with
the
set
Conclusion
agreement
is
reflexive,
E. 11.13
the
relation
»
is
an
subsets.
It
c
equivalence
relation
in
E
and
In
each
determines t h e partition of E into c l a s s e s of It
can
easily
be
seen
that
Conclusion
of
its
abstraction. 11.12
and
Definition
64
CHAPTER II
II.8 yield CONCLUSION
11.14
M - - c'„c
A class
of
abstraction
vtith
respac
t
to
tKe
rotation
> is
a
c
syntactic
category
a representative Thus
vith of
that
Definition
previously
tho
ind»x
of
the
expression
that
is
class.
II.9
and
Conclusion
11.14
yield
the
announced
THEOREM II.6. which
has
is
The family
etfual
to
the
Ct
of
(fuotient
all
syntactic
family
E/
categories,
,
is
a
logical
c
classification the
(logical
relation
',
parti
ithich
is
tion) to
of
the
say
that
set Ct
E determined is
a
family
by of
c
syntactic
categories
Cl>
^
it/tich
satisfies
^ 0
- i t
Ct
the
following
consists
of
condi
tionst
non-empty
categories Cli>
_. ^. ^ . CCt, p' Ct ^ Ct^ n Ct Ct„ ,Ct ^:t F a t a -
Let the
U Ct eCt
the
basic
of
- and whose
Ct<.S'>, Ct<.B>, of
well-formed
expressions
follows:
and
the
Ct:
CtCF>
subfamilies
categories,
defined a s
m E
are
pairwise
disjoint
svm equals
E.
'
symbols
following
categories
Ct
which
0>
family
the
of
denote,
family of all
Jf,
respectively,
of the
all
syntactic
family
functor
of
all
categories,
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES DEFINITION
11.11
a.
Ct<S>
m < ct
I ^ € tCS) >,
b.
CKfi) - < Ct
I i; € tCB> >,
c.
CtCF) - < Ct
I ? e
It
can
65
easily
be
seen
(,CF> >.
that.
Definitions
11.11,
11.6
and
11.7,
T h e o r e m 11.4, Axiom I.la and D e f i n i t i o n 11.8 y i e l d CONCLUSION l l . t S
CtCS) - CtCBy U CfCF) ^ C*CB>i*0 ^ CtCFys^B /v C( r?ie
family
expressions of
syntactic
of
all
of is
all
the
syntactic
swm of
categories!
functor
The s e t s
two that
categories non-empty
of
all
of
and
basic
0.
\oell-formed,
disjoint
families
categories
and
that
categories. S, B, F a r e n o n - e m p t y s u b s e t s
II.9b
and
II.6a
and
Theorem
11.13
that
the
relation
•
11.4).
is
an
It
of
E Csee
Conclusions
from
Conclusions
follows
equivalence
in
each
of
those
c
sets.
By
easily
obtain
under
consideration,
ll.l-Il.ll, langxiage.
Definition
has
the
11.11
theorem
been
and
Conclusions
which
described
by
called
a
explains the
11.14 why
system
and
the <Jf )
syntactically
ll.lS
language and
we Jf
Axioms categorial
66
CHAPTER II THEOREM
Il.da.
The
relation
«
determines
a.
logical
c
classi
fication
pairwise is
Clogical
disjoint
to say that
parti
tioTt>
CtCS>
syntactic categories the following
whose
conditions
«*^
Ct^.d^'^^t^S^
U Ct • S. Ct e C t < S > ^
of S into
This
STim equals S.
are
*^'? " ^ ' a ^ ^ ' ?
non-empty,
satisfied!
^ ^ ^ - «^'
F u r t , h e r , S c a n b e p r e s e n t . e d a s t.he s u m c o n s l s t . i n g o f t,he s u m of
all basic
functor
cat.egorles
categories
which
which
yield
yield
B a n d t,he s u m o f a l l
F,
so
that
the
following
condition i s satisfied: Civ)
S-
U Ct^Ct
Ct U U Ct ^ Ct eCtCF) ^
^
U Ct - S /v U Ct - F. eCt<.B> ^ Ct eCtCF> ^
Sec.
II.7.
The fundamental theorems of the theory of syntactic categories
As results several
has in
been two
mentioned
theorems. Their
definitions,
formulation
of
in
fttsc
which but
Sec.II.l
the
discussion
formulation are
not
will
be
TSCL
preceded
by
for
the
essential
conclusions drawn from
of
them
enable
us
to b e t t e r comprehend the nature of both theorems. We
begin
consti tuent
with
of n-th
the
definition
of
the
order of an expression
set
C of all P p and the definition
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES of -the set
C
of
all
The expresislons
consti
tuents
q e C
of
and <j e
67
the expression C
are
read,
p.
respectively:
(j
i s an element, of n-t-h order of p, «j Is an element of p. The definition of C i s inductive. 'P DEFINITION
a.
f
11.12
e
C
« » / > % t .
i4 const i/went equiform
with
o/
that
order
zero
of
a
given
expression
expression.
< e C* •» V "^ . „, X fP " pCt„,t^,...,t > ^ p n>l tj^,t.,...,t eD<(.) '^ '^ 0 1 n
b.
0<j
if
tuent
p is
eQuiform with
of
first
order
of
a compound expression
some \tord of
a given and t is
the expansion
h+i
c.
A consti d.
const i txient tvent
of
of
first
V t reC*
expression
p.
e C ).
order
of a consti
of
p,
tvent
when of
k-th
k>0,
is
a
order
of
p.
t e C ** '^ t e c'^. p n p
order
CONCLUSION
b.
if
a word xehich is
of
of
that
a given
expression
is
a constituent
expression.
The definitions adopted and Axiom 11.10 easily lead us t o
a.
p
P
k+i-th order
of
J
1
fc>0=».CfeC«» ^
A constituent finite
is
11.16
t e C P t ^ C P
^ Q ^ a p ^ t e C , «J x v t i i % ; t * v e C . P
of
a
68
CHAPTER II Pi>om
11.5b
Oefinlt,ion
and
II.2a
11.12,
we
arrive,
Convent.lon by
II.3a
applying
and
Conclusions
mat.heinat.ical
induction,
at. CONCLUSION II.17a
P
P
in accordance wit.h which auny const.it.uent.s of
an expression
of
£
are words of £ which have a cate^^orlal Index. If
p
belong
a
compound
t.o the
belong II.9>
is
t.o
it.s
are
applying
set. E
well-formed
equal
induction
det.ermined
expressions
and
by
Theorem II.3 we easily arrive
t,hen
p does
S, and t.he const.it.uent.s
unambiguously
well-formed
expression,
by
of
expansion
referring
to
p which
Csee
Definilions
not.
Axiom
II.4c,a,b.
Definition
By
11.12
and
at
CONCLUSION II .17b
p « S ^ c " £ C P P in
accordance
with
which
any
=S,
constituents
of
well-formed
expressions are well-formed expressions. Every some
constituent
syntactic
of
a
position.
compound Further,
expression to
every
occupies
in
constituent
it
of
a
<17>
given
compound
sequence ot makes
it
expression
we
oaxx assign
a
finite
natural numbers greater than or equal t o
possible
to
determine
its
syntactic
ordered
zero
position
which
In
that
of
th.6
expression. Let consti
the tuents
symbol of
the
C expression
Cn>0>
denote
the
p Cof order other
set
than 0) u^^lc/l
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES
occupy
in
It
the
adopt, t h e f o l l o w i n g
syntactic
definition
69
position of this
y-Jt,J^,->J^>-
We
term:
D E F I N I T I O N 11.13
** p e p word of the expansion of p,
the
a.
f < s C
b.
Ac > 0
^ Ct e
Juj.^""*- word of
C ^ P
'^
E c
^
t
is
eaxiiform
C P
4* t
the expansion
of
II.13a
and
with
is
the
J.-th 1
»quifoT«t
with
of
set
a constituent
the
" >.
From
Definitions
and
b
II.12b
and
c
we
easily
arrive by induction at the following conclusions: CONCLUSION
11.18
n>0=*C
* ^
" S C " P
P The
constituent
determined
by
of
the
the constituent
p
n-term
of n-th
which
occupies
setfuence
order
of
of
in
it
natural
the
posi
tion
numbers Cn>Oy is
p.
C O N C L U S I O N 11.19 N.
rt
^^
^n
*
P Every the
consti tuent
syntactic
natural
We further
.
n~th
position
^
J„>
order
determined
Cn>0) of by
1
^
n ^
P
an
p occupies
n-term
in
seifuence
it of
numbers.
now proceed analyses,
replacement
of
a
to formulate of
the definition, important for
the four-argument
consti
tuent
of
an
relation
expression
> of token.
Its
70
CHAPTER II
formulat.lon reltxtion
of
The
requires
adopt.ion,
Cy"> of
ttxs Teplacsmeixt
a givon
expression
expression
obt.alned
t.he
from
of
lnduct.ion,
a constituent
Is
read:
expression
s
by
t.he
expression
t.he
n-th
order
the
expression
rCp/tfys
is
read
r
replacemen-t
c o n s t i t u e n t Q o f n - t h o r d e r by t h e e x p r e s s i o n The
of
of
tohen.
rCp/q> s
the
by
Is
of
its
s,
but
p.
analogically
as
rK.p/'tfi
w i t h t h e o m i s s i o n o f t h e p h r a s e "of n—th o r d e r " . Here
are
the
definitions
of
the
relations
under
consideration: DEFINITION
a.
rCp/<j> s 4* s,r
The
expression
replacement expression such
11.14
that
of
its
p if
and
tf is
is
obtained,
from,
constituent only
eQuiform
if
the
s and
with
r
b.
7»>1
r
€S^
of
r are
s and
expression xero
s
order
by
laell-formed
p is
by
eQuifortn
the the
expressions with
r.
e S y->
s ^ , s . , . . . , s e S 0 1 n ^
'^
0
1
'^
n
0
i
n
ro,r^.....r^eS
0
expression
replacement expression expressions
of p
if with
r its and
is
obtained
from
constituent only
expansior\s
if
tf s
and
consisting
the of
r
expression first
are of
order
compound the
same
s
by by
the the
well-formed number
of
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES
veil-formed
expressions,
while
an expression
etfuiform
the
of
expansion
r
al I expressions same
in
replacement and
than
expression
only
r
of if
constitvent
j
is
obtaiT\ed
t
of
k-th the
t by
of
order
by
d. The
finite
is
J which
in
with
p;
equiform
and
r
which
have
the
V
Cr
from q of
from
order
the
expression
k+i-th
s by
s /v vCp/jjJ
by an
replacement
order
the
s
Ck>0?
it
by by
replacement
expression
in
t».
of
v
its
the p
if
of
its
which
is
consti
tuent
q
p.
expression
r
of
above
is
its
from order
The
nvMber
there
rC/>/q)s • • V rCp/q> *.
replacement obtained
s
s
equifornu
obtained
r
the
of
expression
s «•
constitvent
from
first
is
expansion
of
are
its
obtained
the
expansions
k > 0 ^ CrCpyqy
The
lt.s
the
the
q arid having
determines
numbers other
c.
with
in
71
s
by
consti the
Cgreater readings
Just.ificat.lon
obtained
in
tvent
from
the
q
p
by
replacement than
or
of
t^he
the
equal labels
conclusions
of
expression if
and
its
only
by if
constituent
to 0^ by
the r
is
q of
a
p.
rCp/(}> s which
s
and
follow
r<.p/'q'>s directly
has from
D e f i n i t i o n s 11.14 and 11.12 amd C o n c l u s i o n II.6a: CONCLUSION
11.20
a.
rCp^q)
s -^ q e C
b.
rCpyq^s
^ q G C
In a c c o r d a n c e replaced
in
a
with given
^ p e C , ^ p G C .
these
conclusions
expression
is
the its
expression
which
constituent
is Cits
72
CHAPTER II
c:onst.it.uent. a
of
definit,e
const.it.uent.
expression
Cits
that
same
order.
obtained
replacing
Moreover,
expressions
and
const.lt.uent.
is
replaced and the
ordei>>,
of by
the
are
replacing
a
definite
are
order)
of
Further,
constituents
constituents
same
expression
replacement.
constituents
they
occupy
t,he
which
syntactic
of
is the the the
in
compound
position
because
Definitions II.14b and c, 11.13a and b yield by induction CONCLUSION
11.21
r
.
. ^ <. a e C
^^
'h'Jz V ,).
/^ p € C '^ r When
r
interc/ian^ea6le justification
p
and
in
in
s
the
qi
are
often
r.
Such
and
following
called
replacBoble
terminology
conclusion
that
or
has
is
its
obtained
easily from Definition 11.14 and Axiom I.lb: CONCLUSION
11.22
r
r
is
obtained
constitvient
Q
replacement Those
of
by its
p.
from
s
then
e
constituent
constituents
which
by is
the
replacement
obtained.
from
r
of
its
by
the
p by tf. are
replaceable
in
expressions
are
likewise well-formed expressions because we have CONCLUSION
11.23
rCp/<j)s •¥ s,r,q,p which follows
from
the
fact
that
if
G S, rCp/<j)s,
then
s
and
r
are
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES
well-formed Ccf.
by
Definition
Conclusion
II.20>
11.14, .and are
73
-their
constituents
well-formed,
too,
p
in
and
view
q of
Conclvision II.17b. Once
we
agreement of
have
with
described
our
expressions
certain
intuitions,
we
formulate
properties,
connected
and
prove
with the
which the
are
in
replacement
first
of
the
two
fttsc. THEOREM 11.7a
CI f t t s c >
rCp/g>s
^ r « s ^ p « q c
//
an
category
expression as
replacement
wttich
an expression of
to
r,
its
the
P r o o f .
belongs is
constituent
same It
s,
c
to
obtained
the
from
scone the
latter
Q by an expression
syntac
tic
suffices
to
syntactic
p,
then
by
the
p
and
category. prove,
by
applying
the
principle
o f i n d u c t i o n , t h a t t h e f o l l o w i n g lemma holds: LEMMA
11.4
c
I
fttsc
follows
immediately
from
c
that
lemma
by
Definition
II.14d. Now when n"0 II.14a,
Theorem
Lemma 11.4 i s II.3,
obtained
Conclusions
C o n v e n t i o n s II.3a,c. Assume t h a t Cla)
rCpy
and
r
-
St.
directly
II.7,
11.12,
from
Definition
II.13b,c,
and
74
CHAPTER II
We s h a l l
prove
t.hat>
p
m q
and
hence
t.hat.
Lemma
II.4
holds
Definition
II.14b
c
for
n"l. We
from
conclude
the
assumption
Cla>
and
that C2)
r,s e S
and
that
there
are
s^,s
expressions
,...,s
e
S
Cn >1>
and
e S such that
r«
and r - pCrQ,r^,...,r^ >
C4)
and t h a t f o r a c e r t a i n n a t u r a l number j '
such
that
•'I
<5> we
0 < jf
< n
have
<6>
if ^
s
A
and C7>
p % r
and
also
Since s formulas II.9
-
and r a r e C2>-C4!>,
they
than
zero
well-formed
Conclusion
belong
II.4a> and a r e a t
an
A
to
the
unambiguously,
Hence and
II.6a, set
Definition
SN S
<see
II.4c>.
the in
By
Axiom
expansions
view
of
of
11.3b,
and
Definitions
t h e same time e x p r e s s i o n s
CDefinition
injection.
and compound e x p r e s s i o n s
of
II.9 s
and
Definition
II.4b
r
and
the
atnd
greater
function are
by
Axiom
II.3a
an o r d e r
the
-
p
is
determined formulas
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES
C3>
and
C4>
s
respectively.
and
r
Under
sat.isfv
t.he
Convention
75
condlt,ions
II.3c
we
tn s
atnd
record
tn , r
these
conditions, respectively. In the form COS
c
cd,d^,d^,...,d^
C
,d^y
and <10) Since
the
expansions holds,
constituents
are
in
of
well-formed
view
of
s
and
,Cjj>.
r
which
expressions
Convention
II.3c
belong
and
we
the
can
to
their
formula
state,
C8>
on
the
s t r e n g t h of Conclusion II.7, t h a t
*"'
0
follows
referred under
from
to
so
the
far,
Convention
assumption
from
II.3, t h e
Conclusion indices
d
and r, r e s p e c t i v e l y , are equlform s o C12) accordance
ISJ Sn .
In
the
generalized
CIO),
C12>
and
with first
11.12
and c
and of
has
not
been
Axiom
I.lb
that,
the
expressions
s
that
C6>
-
i<J
C7) This
generalized
p
that
II.7, •
time
we
<j. It it
Cll),
d .
d
be
find,
% c .
so
in
refer
order % c
by
H.13b,c
to
,
two
cases:
ourselves
likewise
suffices
that
avail
and
Is
in
catft
and
11.12
concatenation
C12) and
there
case,
Cll>,
11.23,
and
C5>
concatenation
Conclusions
CIO),
which
d m c.
In
on
to from
of
the
Theorem formulas
that
-
and the
in
find, which
view
the
second
to
J^"0
or 1.17 C9), of
formulas case,
for
Theorem
1.18
in
of
C9>,
follows
that
it
view
on
76 p
CHAPTER II -
<,.
We h a v e t.hus demonst.rat.ed t-hat. Lemma II .4 h o l d s f o r Assume
now
that,
a l s o t h a t rCp/Q>
this
lemma
s and r ^
holds
Tor
k>0
and
n«l.
n—h. A s s u m e
s.
c
We s h a l l d e m o n s t r a t e hence t h a t
it
follows
that
from
under t h e s e
the
a s s u m p t i o n s p ^ Q, amd c
assumption
that
f o r n-M
s
that
s
and
k rCv-yty
there
1 w Cp/«j> t .
the assumption stating V Cp/<}> (
are
expressions From
that
r
and Lemma II .4 h a s
the
m s c
Lemma II.4
the
v
and
inductive
we i n f e r
assumption t
such
that
assumption
that
been proved for
holds
v
n^l,
and
• t 1 c* 1
Since
we h a v e
that
P - <»• c
This c o n c l u d e s t h e i n d u c t i v e p r o o f o f Lemma II.4. We now p r o c e e d t o f o r m u l a t e and t o p r o v e t h e s e c o n d
fttsc.
THEOREM II.7b CII f t t s c > rCp/9)s If
an
expression
r
of
const
replacement syntac
tic
its
category
syntactic
as
is
^pmif'^rms.
obtained i txtent
if,
from
an
expression
ef by p tiihich
then
r
and.
s
s
belongs belong
to to
by the
the same
the
same
Definition
II.14d
category.
P r o o f .
The
second
fttsc
follows
from
r
S/%p"<}i»r"is,
and LEMMA
II.5
whose proof,
as
in t h e
casie
of
Lemma II.4, i s
by I n d u c t i o n
with.
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES
77
r e s p e c t fco t h e o r d e r n o f t h e c o n s t i t u e n t <j o f For
n-0
II.14a,
Lemma
Theorem
II .5
follows
II.3,
s.
self-evidently
Conclusions
II.7,
from
11.12,
Definition
II.13b,c
and
C o n v e n t i o n s II.3a,c. N o t e a l s o t h a t f o r n"l t h e Cla)
assumption
rCp/'q)
yields
the
and t h e
formulas
C2>-<11)
s
used
in
the
proof
of
Lemma
11.4,
assumption
P •
9
c
and t h e f o r m u l a s C6> and C7> y i e l d t h e C13)
d.
Cln
view
of
formula
%c .
Conclusions
11.23,
II.7,
11.12
and
II.13b,c
and
in
for
n"!
suffices
a c c o r d a n c e w i t h C o n v e n t i o n II.3c). In to
order
to
find
that
demonstrate
that
r
Lemma
•
s.
11.5 h o l d s
In f a c t ,
since,
by
it
C5>, 0<j'
and
1 1
c
t h e f o r m u l a s Cll> and C13> hold, we h a v e A
d
* c
0<>i
the and
formulais
C9> and
conclude
that
*
k'
<10> hold
d
%
c,
we
may
so
refer
that,
by
C o n c l u s i o n 11.12 and C o n v e n t i o n II.3c we h a v e t h a t T ^ c It
remains
to
prove
that
if
Lemma
to
II .5 h o l d s
Theorem
Axiom
I.lb.
s.
for
a
natural
number n"fc
accordingly
that
t h e same applies
shall
demonstrate
that to
the
the
inductive
formulas
assumption
r<.py
s
holds
and p > <). We c
that
in
such
a
case
r
m s.
and
Since
rCp/Q>
k+1
s
c
we
can
infer,
by
Definition
II.14c,
that
there
are
expressions
78
CHAFTCRII
V, and 1
t^ s u c h 1
t.hat.
It
rCu^/t^) s 1 1
1
and
-U-Cp/q) t^. 1 1
1
Since
v^Cp/Q> t , 1 1
h o l d s we i m m e d i a t e l y h a v e t h a t , v^ • t^ b e c a u s e we h a v e a s s u m e d 1 c 1 t h a t P " <J and Lemma II.5 h a s b e e n p r o v e d f o r nmi. Since c
r ( u / t ) s,
r
m
1 1
s
follows
immediately
from
the
inductive
c
assumption. The t w o f t t s c THEOREM
t a k e n J o i n t l y make i t p o s s i b l e t o
prove
II.7
r
Two expressions if
and only
-formed which
if
of
on replacing
expression belongs
belonging confirms
of
to
Theorem
II.7
of
X heloixg
the
one
to
the
same
of
them
by
£ u>e ohtain same
cannot,
syntac
of
tic
correctness
to
the
be
other
as
used
same
the
tic
category in a
xnell-
expression
category
the
of
syntac
a well-formed
course,
two expressions
the
c
the
as
a
X
former. definition
syntactic
definition
of
category. of
of It
syntactic
c a t e g o r y a d o p t e d i n S e c t i o n 11.6.
S e c . II.8.
The a l g o r i t h m o f c h e c k i n g t h e
syntactic
correctness of expressions
The l a n g u a g e theory
TSCL,
should
be
expression of
X.
The
procedure
X,
which
ahould
an
be
is
to
algorithm defined
in
object
decidable,
algorithm
belongs
the
which
enabling
the
set
to
be
us
S of
investigation is
to
say
to
check
the
well-formed
described
AJduklewicz
of
below
C1935]
that
whether
is and
by
a
the
there given
expressions
a
generalized
intended
to
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES
investigate or
the
syntactic
certain
ideas
pertains
syntactic
connectedness,
correctness
of
to
in
be
found
about
precision,
but
it
we
there
shall
AJdukiewicz
not
seems
i.e.
expressions.
t o compoiind e x p r e s s i o n s o f
comments
79
It
also
refers
[19603. T h a t
be
observe
no
point
the
in
to
algorithm
Jf. When f o r m u l a t i n g
always
to
well-formedness
further
rigour
making
of
those
comments more p r e c i s e . We
begin
algorithm, which
with
several
which,
are
it
usually
general
seems, made
are
on
remarks
somewhat
such
an
on
the
concept
different
occasion.
from
We
do
of
those
not,
of
operations
or
c o u r s e , claim them t o be original. An algorithm operations directives.
is
(IP)
fini
and
the
of
should
Cthe
determined
should
have
number
indicate
earlier one
the
them the
directive of
should a
given
should
define
successive
the
essentiad
directives
should
are
appropriate
several
performance
of
operations about
by
Ceach
effective
Cone o f
should
inform
psychophysical
machine,
an
teness
the
of
per/ormaibility of
teness
others
results
directive
as
defini
a
directives
possibility
operation),
operation,
by
Those such
the
finite>,
sequence
performed
properties secure
a
the
first
operation
known,
and
characteristic
be
once
the
last
feature
of
t h e final operation of a given algorithm). When
formulating
algorithm of a given about
language
the
lad>el o f
checking
the
Jf we
symbolism
Jf i s
the
of
directives
which
well-formedness
avail £.
ourselves First
of
recorded with a finite
of
from all
we
determine
the
the
expressions
of
several
assumptions
assume
that
number o f
every
s y m b o l s . Next
we
80
CHAPTER II
assume they
t.hat.
are
them i s that the
about,
any
two
equiform,
and
about
the
concatenation
about
any
vocabulary
and w h e t h e r for
any
parts to
it
it
and
the
additional and
second is
labels,
remaining
decide
it
that
of
£.
Further
sense
its
of
X
we
Le^niewski's
which
of of
parts
that
of
Jf we c a n
amy
word
has
an
indicate
that which
correspond
corresponds
we
the
index,
aussume
correspond
Finally
from
indicate
of .it
of
assume
a
we
can
it
functor.
is
mereology>
e x p a n s i o n , which p a r t and
whether
whether
of
whether
t w o . We aJso
an e x p r e s s i o n
expression
decide
to
to
the
assume
that
categorial
index
it.
in
with
by the
the
way
label,
treated
belonging t o
the
a
is
made not
not
functors which
structurally
following
to
checking:
calculus, we
force
compound
the
subject
because
binding
a word
above
sentential
x+y • z ,
the
main
are
the
label
are
however, as
of
about
labels
them
example,
notation
information
in
assumptions
of
arithmetical
+. T h e s e
indicate
can
word
expression
laJ>els,. c h o s e n label
three
the
can
we
a
compound
In a c c o r d a n c e
the
of
£
is
Cin t h e
sissigned t o
any
whether
arguments
every
of
it
functor,
successive
we
£,
is
words of
main
for
of
given
of
the
Its
label
labels
of
their
has
ambiguous
an
index name
The s e q u e n c e o f c a t e g o r i a l
I s c a l l e d t h e intermBctiats
conventions. indices
sxpansion
of
tfte
exprossion
the
functors we
cannot
arguments.
arithmetic.
We a d o p t t w o t e r m i n o l o g i c a l
lack
the
expressions;
and
^
because
The it
expression
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES
c6y
pcp^.p^
81
p^j)
which has i t s expauislon in t.he sequence of e x p r e s s i o n s
If and only i f f o r any i CO
i-th
term of t h e sequence
Note t h a t
in accordance
with Conventions
II.3b,c e v e r y
i-th
<0 term of t h e sequence CC> i s t h e c a t e g o r i a l index of
the
i - t h t e r m of t h e sequence <«>. It
is
said
condition of
about
the
sequence
C^> t h a t
it
satisfies
tKe
tnp i f and only' i f t h e index f^ ^0 i s t h e concatenation index a of t h e e x p r e s s i o n p and of t h e indices
the
?-,?_,...,? 1 ^ n, s o t h a t t h e following holds: It
is
assumed
indices t h a t
it
about
every
i s possible t o
finite
sequence
of
decide whether i t
categoriad
does, or
does
not, s a t i s f y t h e condition Itt . Note t h a t i f of
the
t h e sequence
expression
condition
*«,r-. i f
C^> i s
C£> t h e n
the
and
if
only
an intermediate
latter that
sequence
condition
expansion
satisfies
is
the
satisfied
by
CC? Csee Condition I.ll>. Before
we
algorithm
for
shall the
describe t r e e of
compound
formulate checking an
the the
auxiliary
derivation
expression
directives
well-formedness al{;orithm,
Such
a
termed t r e e I of a given expression.
of
namely
Calso termed t h e token.
which
determine
the
expressions,
we
that
of
dendrite)
of
diagram
will
drawing a
given
henceforth
be
82
CHAPTER II
By r e w r i t i n g we
the
want, t-o c h e c k
writing to
we o b t a i n
immediately
write,
the
the
expansion
the
second
compound
below,
expression
the
on one
words equiform of
the
line
of
and t h e
with t h e
expression tree
first
I.
If
whose
well-rormedness
line
same
of
level,
successive
under
tree from
such
By left
components
consideration
every
I.
word
of
we
obtain
a
simple
is
e x p r e s s i o n o r i f s o m e o f t h e m i s a compound w o r d which i s n o t compound
expressions
decomposed tree the if
I of
into the
its
Cand main
not
every
compound w o r d s
of
words
which
expansion, way
we
until
are
in t h e
obtain we
perform
of
the
tree
I
that
such
an
follows
from
one
a
simple
expansion
of
the
a
line
are
whose
expression
case
I.
We
all
on
of
we
words
line
proceed
of
its
In
this
this
way
two. in
elements
write
are
simple
t h e m i s a compound w o r d s which i s n o t By w r i t i n g
the
is
fact is
tree
If,
given expression
successive
of
the
and
the
three
then
expression,
with
element
there
is
in t h e
be
completed.
equiform
compound
the
been
such
line
we
has
word
way a s
cannot
arguments),
each
compound e x p r e s s i o n s . line
such
its
that
under
e x p r e s s i o n s or some of
a
and
word
then
same
obtain
a
in q u e s t i o n
the
compound e x p r e s s i o n s ,
is
functor
expression
contrairy,
hence
last
down t h e
operation
expression obtained that
in
an element
in
in
a
last
of
element
the
finite line
which i s
of
The
a
such
construction
question.
each
a
of
conclusion
number
of
except
the
steps last
r e c o r d e d by m e a n s
a g r e a t e r number o f s i m p l e w o r d s t h a n e v e r y e l e m e n t o f t h e
of
next
line. If
in
tree
I
of
a
given
expression
some
of
its
final
nodes
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES
is
not
a simple
expression), of
that
then
Ajduklewicz final
simple
the
is
nodes
is
not
tl93S]
it of
thoroughly
of
operations
a
given
the
set
then
of
checking
the
arrangedy.
of
If
expression
Cin
under
all are
AJdukiewicz's
consideration
proceed
an
under
terminology
S
the
not
well-formedness
compound
we
is
expression
\a»ll
expression
arranged^,
the
the
thoroughly
from the
u>el I
successive
I
word t h a t
checking
completed:
not
tree
if
of
well-formed
is
expressions
terminology,
Cis a compound
algorithm
expression
consideration
the
expression
83
to
is
perform
well-formedness
the
of
that
expression. The
elements
expression are
in
higher
are
tree
I
ordered
so
that
lines
that
different
of
l i n e , and o u t
o n e i s t h e earlier Once t r e e might
be
compound
of
I has
any t w o
been
the
expression.
out is
thoroughly of
any
the
Tree
above,
of
of II
we
elements which i s
in t h e
saune
in
it,
all
its
obtained in
accordance
elements
by
in
the
line
tree
indices from
which
that
left.
construct
ca.tegoria.1 is
well-arranged
two
e a r I i er
elements
completed,
tree
replacement
established
one
a
which i s s i t u a t e d m o r e t o t h e
termed
successive
of
II,
which
a
given
of tree
I
with
by
the
their
the order
categorial
indices. Before the
formulating
algorithm
of
well - a r r a n g e d intermediate
the
checking
the
compound
expansions
formed of p a r t s of t r e e
directives
the
well-formedness
expression of
of
compound
II. Of any
of
£
princlpad of we
expressions
a
part
of
thoroughly order
of
tree
two such expansions t h a t
the I, one
84
CHAPTER II
is
t,he »ar I i er
which is
an
expansion
of
an earlier
element,
of
expansions
of
t-ree I. Those parts of all
compound
given
tree
II which form intermediate
expressions
expression
are
s ,s
checked
» so
that
with the order fixed for
intermediate
do,
the
or
do
encounter
not, the
satisfy first
the expressions
the
m
condition
correctness that
the
of
of
of
tree
for
find
-
expansions m
tree in -
I
whether
CO<J
expansion
out
of
the
of
checking
been performed,
consideration
is
of
the
a
accordance they
Once
we
the
C0<^<*> which does not
has
under
of
such
satisfy
syntactic
and we conclude
not
well-formed.
If
any compound expression s . CO<J
tree
II
s
algorithm
expressions
I its
satisfies
checking
the
and
conclude
we
the
expression
we find that element
,
we
conditions
intermediate
expansions of
Cfc>l)
Intermediate the
condition
well-formedness that
the
of
expansion m
,
then
expressions
expression
formed the
has
under
of
a
part
adgorlthm
been
of
performed
consideration
is
well-formed. By
making
use
of
the
algorithm
described
above
we
shall
check now the syntactic correctness of two expressions from the arithmetic sentential use
of
real
calculus.
brackets
numbers In
the
as technical
and
one
recording
of
expression those
from
the
expressions
we
symbols which have no indices and are
used in the ordinary way. E x a m p l e
II.1.
range over the s e t
Assume
that
the
variables
x
and
y
of read numbers, and the symbols +, <, and 0
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMMX CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES
denot,e, "less
respecMvely,
than",
and
t-he
the
operat.lon
number
syntactic correctness of the Cni>
zero.
85
of
addiMon,
We
proceed
t,he t-o
relat.ion
check
t-he
expression
X + (y
< 0>.
We c o n s t r u c t t r e e I o f t h e e x p r e s s i o n CTT1> Csee Flg.II.l). .
Fig.Il.l. As
can
be
well-arranged.
T r e e I o f t h e e x p r e s s i o n
seen, We
x+Cy<0)
then
expression
accordingly
Crrl>
construct
is
tree
thoroughly II
of
the
c a t e g o r l a l I n d i c e s o f t h e e x p r e s s i o n Cnl> Csee Pig.II.2>.
•> n
s/'nn
Fig.II.2.
of
T r e e II o f t h e e x p r e s s i o n (rTl>
Trees
I and II o f
three
l i n e s e a c h . The l i n e s o f
expansions: t h a t expression equiform
being
of
the
the
and
letters
under
tree
expressions
checked
w i t h y<0. The
expression
that
II f o r m
which of
consideration
the
is
two
Intermediate
equiform
expression
which atre e q u i f o r m
consist
with
with
the
which n and
is s
86
-
CHAPTER II
and
of
which
are
part-s
expressions
which
expressions,
and
category
sentential
the
of
Indices
of
recorded symbols index the
which
indices carrying
out
checking case
which
the
the
of
determined
the
root
of
tree
I
II main
is
Cthe
not
root
a well-formed
expression
II.2. from
not
/
forms,
of
satisfy
that
I)
check
sentential
reasons
indices)
the
and
that
are using The
index
the
indices
we
the
functor.
the
When
algorithm
find
of
that
in
of the
Intermediate
expansion
the
condition.
required
expression of
and
fuunctor.
arithmetical
the
successively,
of
the
to
symbols.
indicates
first
of
name
notation
technical
expressions
tree
We
the
Cn2> Its
of
as
concatenation
of
arguments
E x a m p l e
a
certain
indicate,
the
of
typographical
operations
Crtl)
indices
belong
linear"
functor
functor
successive
which
of
arguments
does
category
For
slant
of
respectively,
the
/
symbol
essentiad
tree
of
the
the
given
expression
index
expression
a
with
successive
The
t-o
Cconcatenations
well-formedness
by
are,
expressions
that
the
the
-
expressions.
before
after
of
of
equiform
occurs
occur
II
"quasi-fractional
are
expression
which
indices
the
tree
belong
functors
in
which
of
which
the
the Hence
is
the
index
of
that
indices
of
the
the
expression
expression.
the
syntactic
correctness
of
calculus:
p •• C-i <-i) V p>. tree
expression shown in
I
Fig.II.4.
is
shown IS
in
Fig.II.3.
thoroughly
It
can
well-arranged.
be
seen Its
that
tree
the II
is
87
THE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES p-»C-iC-i>vp>
Pie.II.3.
T r e e I o f t h e e x p r e s s i o n
sySS
•. S
OS
s/s
Flg.II.4. Trees now
under
that
accordance first
index
of
index
of
expression that
and
II
T r e e II o f t h e e x p r e s s i o n Cn2> of
the
consideration
expression
carrying
the
I
out with
the
of
expression
The
three
of
satisfies
functor
second
of
lines
intermediate
those the
of
the
desired is
that
Indices o f
expression each.
the
intermediate
a
Tree
II
adgorithm -
we
condition
so
forms
successive expso^sion
-
In that
that
the
of
the
Cl.e.,
the
arguments also
of
When
find
concatenation
functor
Cn2)
expansions.
expansions
implication which
calculus
four
operations
order
Crr2>> and t h e
functor.
consist
basic
the
expansion the
sentential
determines the
s/s
of
satisfies
CHAPTER [I
88
the
desired
the
contrary,
condition
condition the
tn
-
In t h i s
third
.
Hence
expansion we
under c o n s i d e r a t i o n i s n o t E
x
a
m
p
l
e
case
can
the
does
c o n d i t i o n TO , -
not
conclude
satisfy that
the
the
On
desired
expression
well-formed. II.3.
We
shall
nov
examine
the
w e l l - f o r m e d n e s s o f a n o t h e r a r i t h m e t i c a l e x p r e s s i o n , namely
X • Cy + < - « » -
In r e c o r d i n g pertaining the
that
to
the
brackets.
expression
determines eight
v> + <x • C-e)>.
expression
we
observe
constants
•,
+,
-,
tree
I
We
aind
Cx
construct
note
that
each
the
the
tree
usual
conventions
variables
and has
tree
x,y,s,
II
five
of
this
lines
and
expansions.
X- < y - K - « ) ) - C x y ) + < x - C-«>)
Cxy)+Cx
Flg.II.5.
T r e e I o f t h e e x p r e s s i o n C7T3)
and
<-«))
TOE AXIOMATIC SYSTEM TSCL OF SIMPLE CATEGORIAL LANGUAGES
89
n
« rkynn
n/'n
• Fig.II.6.
In
carrying
out
T r e e II o f t h e e x p r e s s i o n the
checking t h e s y n t a c t i c the
eight
I
of
which
basic
operations
correctness
intermediate
n^n
algorithm
<7T3> we f i n d t h a t
of
main
o f e a c h compound e x p r e s s i o n which i s a n e l e m e n t o f
tree
Cf73> that
Is
a
condition
concatenation
functor
forms
and
so
of
that
the
the
the
index
of
index
of
the
expression
indices
of
the
successive
a r g u m e n t s of t h a t f u n c t o r . This s h o w s t h a t c o n s i d e r a t i o n Is well-formed.
by t r e e
each
the
desired
determined
of
(nS)
the
expansions
of
of
." ^
II o f
satisfies functor
on
the expression
under
CHAPTER
III
THE THEORY TSCto-L OP CATEOORIAL o-LANGUAOES
S^c. III.l.
Inlroduct-ory remarks
The
t-heory
TSCL
described
certain
sense.
This
is
mathematical new
theories
expressions,
namely e x p r e s s i o n s variables.
It
retaining observed the
formulated in
therefore,
correct
natural
the
that
modify
so
The
point
view
in
include
languages, those
TSCL -
while
Sec.II.l
and
in
that
a
bind
it
should
syntactic
of
in
which
categorial
to
-
poor
formulated
languages
described
above.
from
are
and o p e r a t o r s
constructed
mentioned
in
simple
objectives
when TSCL w a s
expressions,
theorems
occurring
main
lau-iguages
most
with variables
seems,
the
which
because
are
not
languages
cover
amalysis theory
of
of
the
of
use
of
categorial
of
splitting
s y n t a c t i c c a t e g o r y , should be r e s p e c t e d , t o o . In
such
indices
an
in
analysis
we
accordance
usually
with
make
the
principle
e x p r e s s i o n s i n t o "main f u n c t o r s and t h e i r The
method
structure and
of
operators
mentioned trouble
of
using
lioguistlc that
already
connected
by with
of
other
"typical
the
the
in
the
expressions
bind
connectedness is
indices
them
the
ambiguity" 90
of
can
the
syntactic
include
variables
many
problems,
encountered
in
119331. One
algorithm
expressions
study
which
has
AJdukiewicz
arguments".
now of
of
of
checking under
the
them the
is
syntactic
consideration;
operators
the
which
the bind
THE THEORY OF TSC(0-L OF CATEGORIAL (D-LANGUAGES
variables for
belongins
instance,
the
if
we
arithmetic
syntactic variables sets,
to
then
that the
expressions
the
natural
categories and
different
admit
of
of
of
e.g.,
syntactic
distinction,
numbers,
name
<x | x>5>
and
the
between
which
operators
categories. in
variables:
variables
equiform
as,
91
language
of
<X | XSN>
of
two
different
of
individual
that
stsind
Thus,
for
the
names
of
abstraction
in
would
different
have
such
indices. I t i s l i k e w i s e when we c o n s i d e r e x p r e s s i o n s s u c h '^ Cp V - i p > p
in
which
eqxjlforni the
the with
category
operators, the of
a n d '^ X = X
namely
symbol
^,
sentences
the
bind,
and
a
as
X,
universad
respectively, variable
of
quantifiers,
a
the
variaJile
of
category
of
names. The
elimination
ambiguity" o f of into
a
of
operators
syntactically diversiform
conventions
^
in
in t h e
operator
accordance
R.Suszko
and which
quantifier
which
conception
of
typical
variables
may c o n s i s t
related
C19583,
the
"typical
appropriate
matrking
and with
to
thus
splitting
definite
tl964]>.
For
it
caligraphic
instance
the
1
quantifier
the
difficulties
ambiguous
signs
0 symbols
the
^ binds binds
could a
belonging
to
used
sentential a
L.Borkowskl ambiguity
be
of
name [1958]
denote
variable
variable, the
Cproper>
different
to
au-id
universal
the
universal
respectively.
obstacle
which
categories
r e m o v e d by t h e a d o p t i o n o f t h e c o n v e n t i o n t h a t
In
connected
quantifiers
syntactic
the
the
could
index o f
the with bind be the
92
CHAPTER HI
synt-act-ic of
t.he
cat.egory
of
quant.ifler
quant.ifiers
variable
C-the
is
independents
variable
which
of
t,he
index
accompanies
t,he
q u a n t i f i e r >. The
problems
connected
syntactic
categories,
could
eliminated
be
defined
by
in
C1935!l
occur.
the
result
full
system
by
obtained
by
the
the
not
quauitiflers
of
infinity
This
from
the
system
there,
language
occur.
Cwithout
which
do
not
simple
system do
the
simple
suffices
to
however,
a
terms
this
it
of
which
bound
practice, which,
while
syntactic problem include
and
system
of
the
infinity).
As
it
form
the
possibility
have
become
it
therefore
is
retaining
categories, of
the
operators
the
would
syntactic and
every
eliminating
the
make
rooted
ideas it
type
theory
the
the
full
axiom
of
mathematics.
Is
quantifiers
in
and
bound
mathematical
seeking of
possible
connectedness variables
eliminating
mathematics?
worth-while basic
of
logical
operators
known,
of
the into
a
and
with
foundations
deeply
of
simple is
of
brought
thesis
enriched
of
be
do
mentioning
thesis
possibility
be
the
operators
variables
full
theory
could
defining
which
can
to
type
the
variables
worth-while
theory
o t h e r o p e r a t o r s from t h e language of Operators
is
the
quantifiers.
of
in
[19351:
type
bind
Include
possibility
of
with
operators
with a synonymous
of
the
and h e n c e
which
points
the
axiom
the
J.Stupecki
correspondence
indices,
if
with
one-to-one in
operators
means
In c o n n e c t i o n
of
the
mentioned
quantifier
not
the
general
expressions
AJduklewicz universal
of
with
of by
the to
a
solution
theory approach
expressions them
by
of the
which applying
THE THEORY OF TSCoyL OF CATEGORIAL m-LANGUAGES
93
AJduklewicz's inet.hod o f making u s e o f It.
is
subject
worth
endeavours
method
so
that
operators more
or
C19581,
it
that less
syntactic
could
cover
them. the
categories.
For
C1964]
Polish
made the
Those
modify of
in
objects
and
the
and
the
deviate
theory
works as
the
AJduklewicz's
however,
of
the
used
of
variables
principles
the
[19781
literature
endeavours,
are
and
to role
instance,
indices
A.Nowaczyk
the
general
expressions
also
in
been
bind
[1960],
that
have
from
co-ordinating <see
no-ting
indices.
of
of
R.Suszko
Instruments
which
B.Stanosz
they
and
of
denote
A.Nowaczyk
[1976]>. In
the
modifying ideas
present TSCL
chapter
in
such
and complying
syntactically be
with
categoriad
able
as
to
of
expression tokens
by
them
To
simplify
may
set -
while
goals
of
languages, the
ourselves
Such
analysis
one
in
we those
variable
the
each
and
languages
variables
termed
may
that
that
include
the
bound
oy-languages.
convention
languages
of
Sec.II.l
categorial
be
of
theory
in
and t h e
will
adopt
a
discussed
syntactically
task
AJduklewicz's
constructing
as
languages
the
retaining
i n which o p e r a t o r s
occurring
bind o n l y
way
the
discuss
occur. our
expressions which
to
a
we
the
operators
ratnge
of
such
(23)
operators however, could include of
is that
not
be
confined the
and
one
expression.
considerations
generalized
expressions
vau>iables
to
with the
so
as
carried to
quantifiers
languages
cover that
which
o p e r a t o r s t h a t h a v e a f i n i t e number o f
It out
does in
the bind
Include
not
this
seem, chapter
languages a
finite
which number
expressions
arguments.
with
94
CHAPTER III
It.
Is
t-he
theory
TSCe»-L
which
is
the
conception
pertaining
to
the
oi-languaiges.
any
u-language
Jf.
That
language
fixed
ordered
It is
is
theoretical
concerned
characterized
with by
an
system
Cu-J? )
whose
formal
V, Vr,
elements
axioms
and
O, W; is, c;
satisfy
I
,1;
L, p,
definite
definitions
of
C / v > ; E, S,
conditions
TSC«»-L.
In
CtCSy>,
formulated
next
by
the
to
the
concepts occurring in the ordered system < Lb; V, V; %, C; 7 , i; (,, p; E >,
CC ) c
o
described
by
the
theory
TETk
of
expression
tokens
Csee
Sec.II.4> and t o t h e c o n c e p t s o f t h e s e t S o f a l l w e l l - f o r m e d e x p r e s s i o n s and t h e f a m i l y C t CS> o f a l l s y n t a c t i c c a t e g o r i e s o f S,
which
occur
described are
In
new
in
CJf ) c
the
expression Inclusion
set
the
are,
for
differently
Vr
of
all
Cfv>
token.
in
but
somewhat
O, and t h e relation
given
Their
TSC«»-L
concepts:
operators a
also
They
of
conceptual
than
in
be
the
a fi-ee
of
there set
variable
discussed
apparatus
reasons,
TSCL,
variablss, being
will
obvious
in
of in
Sec.III.3.
TSC»»-L
shows
t h a t i t s s t o r e o f c o n c e p t s i s r i c h e r t h a n t h a t o f TSCL. Before of
TSC«*-L
that of
we p r e s e n t we
shall
theory to
the
axioms, basic definitions
point
TLTk and i t s
to
certain
and
relationships
expansion, t h a t
e x p r e s s i o n t o k e n s , which i s a f r a g m e n t
is the
and a t
theorems which
theory
the
same
link TETk time
t h e c o r e o f TSCL CSec.III.2). The adopted
definition in
of
TSCwL
the
concept
CSec.III.4)
Is
of a
well-formed modification
expression of
the
THE THEORY OF TSCo)-L OF CATEGORIAL (O-LANGUAGES
definition It
of
t-hat,
possible
describe and
to
the
which
II.7a,b
CI
describe
the
syntactically
II
in
to
fttsc>. of
correctness)
of
Theorems
checking those
it the
expressions
The Toundations or TSC««-L
tokens
TSC«»^L i s batsed on t h e
while t h e
latter
is
in
II.2,
turn
it
theory
based
II.6a
and
possible
to
connectedness
which
may
TETk of
on t h e
which
CSec.III.S)
II.4,
syntactic
Sec.
makes
theorems
makes
bind variables CSec.III.6).
The theory
It.
u-lamsuages
operators that
III.2.
CSec.II.5>.
fundamental
Further
algorithm
TSCL
categorial
analogous
and
Csyntactic
adopted
formulate
are
the
concept,
95
include
expression
theory
TLTk of
label tokens. Note having
<see its
concepts
Sec.II.4>
apparatus and
by
Definitions II.12a-d,
that
enriched
axioms
Il.la,
II.13a,b>
TETk
and
by
new
obtained
the
TLTk
and
CAxioms
II.2a,b,
establish
from
primitive
definitions
II.l,
which
is
by
secondary
II.l-II.lO
II.3a-c,
and
11.8-11.10,
properties
of
those
concepts. In
connection
with
this
and
in
accordance
with
Conventions
I.la.b and II.3b t h e following remark is t o be made: REMARK III.l. TETk,
namely
The Lb,
W, %, c,
symbols
of
, / , L, p, o c o n s t a n t symbols of t h e vocabulary of TSC»»-L. The variable
V,
constant
symbols
of
the
/
vocabulary
of
the E,
vocabulairy Ct,
•, c
of
C p
are
TSCwL include
the
96
CHAPTER III
let.t.ers Cw
>
p,tj,r,s,t,vi,v,...,
w h i c h rani^e o v e r
The
over
remarks
t w o metatheorems
a n d Remark pertaining
III.l
enable
us
to
t o TSC«»-L.
Every tKesis
Caccopted
sentenced of TETk
is
Every thosis
Caccsptsd. sentenc&> of TLTk
is
of TSC«»-1^
T H E O R E M III.2 .
Note
subscript,
t h e family 2
T H E O R E M III.l .
a thssis
subscripts,
/; t h e letter
preliminary
formulate
a tKesis
fC, w i t h o r w i t h o u t
X, w i t h o r w i t h o u t
which r a n g e s
subscripts,
Z.6; t h e l e t t e r s
a.,b,c,d.,^
which ran^e o v e r
with o r without
of TSC«»-L. that
we
have
retained
a
convention
su-ialoguous
to
Conventions 1.2 and II.1, namely C o n v e
n
t
1
o
n
III.l.
The
theses
(accepted
sentences) whose numbers are marked with an asterisk are
theses
of the metatheory of TSCt^L. Theorem
III.l
enables
us
to
arrive
at
the
conclusion
to
which we shall refer on numerous occasions. CoNci^usioN III.l . TSC*r-L li.ea.b.
inctudei
Il.iOa.b.
Axioms
II.3a-c.
Conclusions
Il.la.b. II.17a,
The
Caccepted
II.1-II.10;
11.8-11.10. Il.Sa.b. 11.18.
theses
Definitions
II.iaa.-d. II.3,
11.19.
II.13a.b;
II.4a-c.
sentences) II.la,
of II.i.
TKeorem II. 1;
11.5a-c,
II.1B-14.
THE THEORY OF TSC
By
ret-aining
analogon in.2 , III.l
of
the
an
expression
Remarks -
the
deflnit-lon
II.3
and
conclusion
of
97
Csee TLTk
II.2
made
which
is
Sec.II.2>
we
of
obtain
in
-
Sec.II.2,
analogous
the by
and
to
dual
Theorem Conclusion
Theorem
II.3 ,
namely CONCLUSION (accepted, In
Every
sentence)
in
connection
with
convenient, of
III.2 .
this
when
TLTk is the
to
analogon
a thesis
in
TSCt*-L
observe
is
the
of
a.
thesis
TSCt»-L.
relationships
presenting
chapter,
dual
shown
the
above
successive
conventions
it
is
sections
introduced
in
Chap.II. H e n c e we h a v e C o n v e n t i o n
III.2.
We
retain
Convention
II.2
CSec.II.2) a n d C o n v e n t i o n s I I . 3 a - d CSec.II.5).
Sec.III.3.
Operator expressions
We now concepts
add
to
the
conceptual
which
do
not
occur
in
TSCL
c o n c e p t s i n TSC«r-L. T h e y a r e : t h e CO-language £,
a n d t h e set
Kr of
The
sense
we
intuitive
sets,
that
deviate of will
from
formal be
variaible.
is,
which
respectively,
the
Thus,
set all
to for
Note,
denote
impart
to
however,
instance,
label by
of
TETk
which
are
all
and to
that which
the
of
the
two
that
elements variables,
them
new
primitive
operators
variables
operators
a
and
O of
o n e w h i c h we i m p a r t
disciplines. used
apparatus
of
the
language. of
those
does
not
In t h e
languages
term
"operator"
the does
universal
not
include
quantifier
a we
98
CHAPTER III
mean t.he graphic sign ^ and not. such graphic symbols a s ^, ^, and by t.he algebraic sign o f summation we mean ^ and n o t , say, 00
z fc«l This i s s o because we adopt AXIOM III.l
O u Vr ^ E . s
The set
of a l l o p e r a t o r s ccnd. th.e set
s u b s e t s of the set In
accordance
of simple with
expression
Axiom
III.l
of
a l l •uaria<>les ore
tokens. and
Definition
II.3a
we
arrive a t CONCLUSION III.l a.
O S K /N O £ DCi.>,
b.
Vr S V ^ Vr S DCL:>.
Thus o p e r a t o r s and variables a r e simple word tokens of t h e CO-language Jf under consideration which have Indices. In
the
operators
vocabulary that
Conclusions
V of
would
II.2b
and
the
be Ill.la
(<>-language
"typically and
JP t h e r e
are
ambiguous", Convention
no
because
11.3c
Csee
Convention III.2> yield CONCLUSION in.2a p,<}
The indices Likewise, yield
^ 0 / \ p ^ Q ^ a S i b .
of eqvi/ornt operators Conclusions
II.2b
and
are Ill.lb
etfuiform. and
Convention
I1.3c
THE THEORY OF TSC(0-L OF CATEGORIAL CO-LANGUAGES
99
CONCLUSION III.2b
p,q The
indices
We a l s o
of
e Vr
eqxiiform
assume
about
^ p % q ^ a % 6 . variaAlss
the sets
ars
eQui/orm.
O and Vr t h a t
they
satisfy,
r e s p e c t i v e l y , a x i o m s which a r e anaiog^uous t o Axiom 1.10: AXIOM III .2
p e O / v t % p > » ( € 0 . A Itxbel
token
latiich
is
etfuiform
with
an operator
is
also
an
operator. AXIOM III.3 p e Vr
A label
token
lahich
/\ ( % p ti^ t €
is
equiform
with
Vr.
a variable
is
also
a
variable. It is often emphasized of
the operators
that
is that
binding role of an operator which
include
cj-language
operators.
operators
can
is revealed
To
Jf we distinguish
one of the essential
describe
bind
variables. The
in definite
such
functions
structures
structures
in the
the set E of all expression
from
tokens of Jf its subset pCOxKrxO, whose elements will be termed operator
expression
operator
expression
tokens
of
the to-language
of that language. Operator
J? or, briefly, expressions are
thus the values of the function p restricted to the set
OxVrxE.
They are thus compound expressions consisting of an operator, a variable, and an expression token, in that order. In
our
further
analyses
we
shall
make
use
of
the
100
CHAPTER III
a b b r e v i a t . i o n i n t . r o d u c e d by t h e m e t . a l i n ( ; u i s ' t i c DEFINITION p which
p^Cp^,p^,p^> is
thesis
In
K
other with
the
of
a
an
side
of
that
said
expression The
sign
standing
elements
of
sign,
by
an the
to
with
of
In
one
side
standing
expression
every
on
an
of
the
on
the
equiform
the
one
substitution that
the
P-^^^'
construction,
standing
of
^
replace.
the
an
appropriate
expansion
p^eVr
that
replace
side
t-o
on
expression
other
^
under
standing;
and the
us
now
equiform
for
on
allows
TSCw-L that
A p^eO
side
for
the
sign.
operator
expression
P *^^0'^1''*2 '
i.e.,
the
elements
successively,
- the
xohich
p
-
indexicgil
The
token"
the
the main
the
sequence operator
of
the
operator
Pn>P^>P^> of
the
operator p ,
p
are
called,
expression
<<5 ) ,
p_ o r t h e -
the
variable
scope
of
the
p . expression
consisting its
of
variable
accompanies
operator
and
vhlch
with
the
t<5 >
p
rule
expression
substitution
the
p m pCp^,p^,p^->
theory
equiform
by
a
^
fact,
of
expression sign
III.l
of
the
scope we
p .
shall
C<5 > i s main
the
operator
Instead often
read:
of use
operator
p ,
the
its
term
the
expression
indexical "operator
shorter
token
variable
p.
expression
form
"operator
expression'". The
adopted
terminological conventions
will
be
used
later
in
t h e v e r b a l f o r m u l a t i o n o f f u r t h e r t h e s e s o f TSC«»-L. The
following
conclusion
is
a
specified
version
of
THE THEORY OF TSC(0-L OF CATEGORIAL 0>-LANGUAGES
Conclusion
II.3;
it
follows
101
from
the
latter
and
Definition
III.l*. CONCLUSION III.3
p - p^
-^ <J - p'^C<jg,^^,<j2> •» •»
Two operator main
expressions
operators,
ths
scopes
the
of
We h a v e
those
otre e
indexical
variables
operators
are
t h e following
if of
and
only
those
if
their
operators
and
equiform.
theorem
which
is
analoguous
to
Axiom
token
Q is
11.10: THEOREM III.l
p » p^
If
p is
etfuiform
an operator vtith
expression
the
that
it
ajui
operator, the of
if
operator
-
and
then
only
expressions
indexical
operator,
III.l ,
expression
the
indexical
The
•»<<}% p «^
are
variable
-uariable equiform of
if
an expression q
of
its
of
that
wt th
that
is
also
an
expansion
-
operator the
operator
main and
operator the
main
and the
scope
operator scope
of of
p. that
respectively. proof Axioms
of
this
11.10,
theorem III.2
and
is
obtained
III.3,
from
Convention
Definition 11.3a
and
Conclusion II.4c. The concept of the relation
C/v.> of
being
a free
variable
in
102
a
CHAPTER III
given
expi^ession
TSC«-L.
That,
t.oken
relat,ion
is
is
a
secondary
defined
by
Cderived>
the
concept,
expression
in
p
which i s r e a d : p i s a f r e e varlatble i n t-he e x p r e s s i o n t o k e n Q. DEFINITION III.l P-UJQ
•»
p ^
^'^ ^
^''•o'^l''2 p is p is
is
^
variattls
a variable
there of
a fT«s
the
the
scope
of
and
at
with
the
^
0
1
2
the
q
same
p is
main
indexical
C
expression
variable the
e
in an expression
no operator
tf and
p
time
the
operator
variable
of
that
r
it
time
and
that
q, if
"
is
i
and only
a constituent
same
of
r^
token
r such at
^
of a
if
q and constituent
a constituent
of
a variable
eefuiform
operator.
D e f i n i t i o n III.l and C o n c l u s i o n II.Ida i m m e d i a t e l y yield CONCLUSION III.4
pCfv'yef y. s S: tf ^ If
p is
a free
a free
variable
The
variable
in an expression
in an expression
concept
of
a
bound
associated
with
A variable
which i n a g i v e n o p e r a t o r
main
operator
is
of
a
operator
and e q u l f o r m
operator
expression
variable
a free
free
p
such
with
by
variable
variable
with
token
etfuiform
variable
that
pCfv^s.
its
a
within
bound by t h e main o p e r a t o r
• p
it
is
cf. given
expression
p
thjen
operator
in a given
indexical
that
q.
is
expression.
i s bound by i t s
the
scope
variable.
of
Thus
p ^Pf.fP^,Py'>, if
and only
then
said
if
that In
Po
an
^^^ ^
P^^fW>p
(24)
and
p_
%
p .
The operator
p
Is
to
bind
the
THE THEORY OF TSC(i>-L OF CATEGORIAL(i>-LANGUAGES
variable
p_.
The o p e r a t o r to
103
bind any
voidly
in
free
binding
a
given
variable
in t h a t
operator
in
its
operator
scope.
is
voidly
binding
in
a
there
is
no
free
variable
in
its
which
include
binding
We t h e n
expression.
operator
voidly
expression
given
The
scope.
operators
of
the
definition
of
of
ordieT
n
we
shall
refer
the
the
of
the
set
<<>-language set
to
the
be
replaced
of
all
will
be
all
it
is
We a l s o s a y t h a t
an
expression
Operator
are
not
expressions
included
in
based
recording
II.3b,c
the by
\aell-/ormed
DEFINITION
Csee
term the
on
the
inductive
expression
tokens
of
this
definition
Convention
"well-formed
shorter
term
III.2>.
"well-formed
III .2
p e
S 4 i » p € S v
c"**
.
p^,p^,p^,p^
At
^ P2 ^
S ^ p^C/v^p^
^P '
P"
3
'^ P3 =K P j -^ C
<.a,a^,a^,a^>y,
in
expression
s
.
the
expression
expression".
b.
if
X.
itell-formed
symbolic
Convention
formulations
will
S
Jf
S o/
C7i>0>. In
verbal
token"
that
not
Weli-formed e x p r e s s i o n s
definition
tokens
say
operator
well-formed e x p r e s s i o n s of t h e oj-language
S e c . III.4.
may h a p p e n
^
104
CHAPTER III 00
c.
S -
In
U "S. nmO
accordance
with
Definition
III.2a
a
e x p r e s s i o n of order 0 Is a simple e x p r e s s i o n of
well-formed the
oi^-language
X. In
accordance
with
Definition
III.2b
a
well-formed
e x p r e s s i o n of order k+i i s 3tn e x p r e s s i o n which s a t i s f i e d
one of
t h e following t h r e e conditions: 1
p is
a well-formed
element of t h e s e t 2 all
expression
of
order
k,
and hence
S,
p i s a compound e x p r e s s i o n of t h e oj-lanjfuage £ such t h a t elements
of
its
expansion
PntP^r—rP
are
well-formed
e x p r e s s i o n s of order Ai, which i s t o say t h a t they are of
an
the
set
S; f u r t h e r ,
the
main functor
p^ of
elements
p Is
not
an
o p e r a t o r ; finally p s a t i s f i e s t h e condition m
c
In accordance functor
of
indices
a ,...,a
with
which
the
cate^^orial
p i s a concatenation of of
all
index a
of
t h e index a of
successive
arguments
expression,
the
of
the
main
p and the
the main
functor, 3
p is
an
operator
matin o p e r a t o r
which binds a c e r t a i n variable p„ which i s f r e e which i s a well-formed
e x p r e s s i o n of order
p
of
in i t s scope p^
k.; t h e
index a„
of
t h a t o p e r a t o r i s a concatenation of t h e index a of p, t h e index a
of t h e Indexical variable p
of
that
operator
a^ of i t s scope p ; p t h u s s a t i s f i e s t h e condition
and t h e
index
THE THEORY OF TSCco-L OF CATEGORIAL oo-LANGUAGES
In a c c o r d a n c e all
sets
of
with
Definition
well-formed
105
III .2c t h e s e t - S i s t h e s u m o f
expressions
of
a
finite
order
C^reater
t h a n o r equal t o zero>. We
now a d o p t
two
terminological
e x p r e s s i o n p f o r which t h e r e satisfies compound
the
condition
non-operator
conventions.
i s a naturaJ. number
2°
will
be
expression.
A
3
We s h a l l
u s e t h e symbols
well-formed all
will b e t e r m e d
a
well-formed
compound
well-formed
a well-formod
S
and S
non-operator
operator
well-formed
At s u c h t h a t
termed
f o r which t h e r e i s a n a t u r a l number k s u c h t h a t condition
A
^aell-formed expression
p satisfies
operator
t o denote,
expressions
expressions,
p
p the
expression. t h e s e t of all
and t h e
set
respectively.
of The
d e f i n i t i o n s of t h e s e c o n c e p t s a r e recorded a s follows: DEFINITION
III.3
p ^ S"'^ ^)^
n>l
^ p^,p^,...,p^^
y. p DEFINITION
^ O ^ C
fc.
^^ " PtPo'Pi' 'P„> S
Ca,a ,...,a
.<XQ>5-
III.4
s " •• y k
V pQ'Pi'p2'P3
cp • p^(.p^,p^,p^^
^ ^2 ^
^ •^
3 '^ P^^f'*>^p2 -^ P3 * Pj -^ *= *-°'°l'*'2''*0''"*' Note compound the
that
the
concept
non-operator
concept
of
the
of
the
expressions set
SS S
set is of
S
of
all
well-formed
i n TSC«»-L am a n a l o g o n all
well-formed
of
compound
106
CHAPTER III
expressions. be
not-ed
Introduced t.hat.
operator-free
a
In TSCL, ( s e e
non-operat.or
expression there
main f x i n c t o r
of
expression
expression
o n e : i n t-he e x p a n s i o n
non-operator
that
which
of
a
It. must, need
furt-her
not,
well-formed
be
an
an o p e r a t o r
operator
an
compound
may o c c u r , a s a n a r g u m e n t
expression,
has
Sec.II.S>.
of the
expression
expressions
o r an
as
its
constituent. In f o r m u l a t i n g have
availed
compound
this
ourselves
non-operator
remark, of
and e a r l i e r
the
fact
expression
is
t h e Condition
that a
2 , we
every
well-formed
compound
expression.
D e f i n i t i o n 111.3, LEMMA III.l
"^S £ E c o c o . D e f i n i t i o n II.3b and Axiom II.9 y i e l d CONCLUSION 111.5a
c Lemma III.l
is
an analogon
of
Lemma
II.2. I t s p r o o f
is
given
i n t h e Annex. Definitions
III.4,
III.l*,
Conclusions
III.la,b
and
11.5b,
D e f i n i t i o n II.3b and Axiom II.9 y i e l d a l s o CONCLUSION 111.5b
c E v e r y e l e m e n t of Note t h a t
th.e s e t S
t h e main f u n c t o r
S , unlike t h e main f u n c t o r
is
a. compounti
expression
of each expression
o f any e x p r e s s i o n
from
from
token. the
set
the s e t S
,
THE THEORY OF TSC<0-L OF CATEGORIAL (0-LANGUAGES
i s a n o p e r a t o r . The s e t s is
a
one-to-one
also
disjoint
III.5a,b
CAxiom
the
fact
a r e thus disjoint
II.9).
the s e t E ,
from
C o n c l u s i o n II .Sa.
and S
function
with
and
S
107
Each
which
of
follows
that,
by
because
p
sets
is
these
from
Conclusions
Definition
II.3a
and
E n E =0. c s
We a d o p t a n axiom a n s d o g u o u s t o Axiom 11.11, namely AXIOM
III.4
.cs""> n I In
the
(x>—I angtiags
non-operator
expression
We a l s o AXIOM
X
there
which
the
and
otherwise,
oi-langvage which S
£
The
compotind index.
and S
Moreover,
follows
earlier analyses
yield
0.
is
applies III.2a,b,
t o o , and t h u s .
t h e sum o f
^
a
uiel l-/ormed
categorial
same
III.4, t h e s e t s S
that
categorial
In
to each
view
operator
index.
a r e non-empty in accordance
by D e f i n i t i o n s
it
o
there
has a basic and S
III.5.
empty,
III.4
\tell~ formed.
III.5
The s e t s
be
tx
adopt
expression
III.4
is
has a basic
tCS"^? n I
In
^ 0.
o
the of
of
set
with E
the sets
Axioms
because In S would
Definitions
III.3
and
III.2c,a,b,
III.3
and
would b e e m p t y .
E ,
from
Definitions
s " " and s " equals
S. T h i s
and t h e
108
CHAPTER III THEOREM
111.2
s - °s u s"" u s" ^ °s »« 0 ^ s"^ .< 0 ^ s" ^ 0 ^ ^ °S n s " " - 0 .V °S n s " - 0 ^ s"^ o s " - 0.
is
The
set
the
SUM of
set
of
S of
S
of
that
all
veil-formed
three
all
non-empty
single titel l-formed
language
and of
This
and
expressions
all
expressions
expressions
that
pairv»ise of
compound
the
set
S
of
the
the disjoint
all
J?
setsi
oi-langttage
non-operator of
ui-language
£,
the
the
set
expressions
of
well—formed
operator
language.
t-heorem.
Definition
III .2c
and
Lemma
III.l
yield
the
u>-language
Immediately CONCLUSION
111.6
0 ^ S ^ E ^ S ^ DCi.y. The is the
set
of
all
a non-empty set
of
Since
set
laord S
III.l
III.l
that
tokens
have
an
it.
follows
O
and
Vr
III.2a,c
of
that
language
X and
index. from
Definition
are
non-empty,
these
sets
are
III.4
and
too.
By
subsets
of
III.7
0
b.
0 i< Kr = S.
i< O =
accordance
operators
of
at
a.
In
which
Definitions
S. Thus we a r r i v e
expressions
expression
non-empt-y
au-id
CONCLUSION
of
tokens
is
Metadeflnition Axiom
viel I-formed
S,
with
and t h e s e t
of
Conclusions
III.7a,b
the
set
of
all v a r i a b l e s a r e non-empty s u b s e t s
all of
THE THEORY OF TSCo>-L OF CATEGORIAL CO-LANGUAGES
109
t-he s e t - o f a l l v e i l - f o r m e d e x p r e s s i o n s o f X.
S e c . III.5.
In the
this
Fundainent.al t^heorems
section
well-formed
to
the theorems
we sh&U
expressions
formulate of
oj-laneuages.
o f TSCL. p e r t a i n i n g
of simple c a t e g o r i a l
theorems
pertaining
They
are
t o well-formed
to
analoguous expressions
languages.
T h e o r e m II.3 h a s i t s a n a l o g o n i n THEOREM III.3
An expression veil-formed
of
the oi—language
expression
This
theorem
is
follows
which i s analoguous
also
£ uiftich
is
equiform
a ttel I-formed
from
Definition
iitith.
its
expression. III.2c
and
the
lemma
expression
of
t o L e m m a II .3:
LCMMA III .2
An order The
expression k is
equiform
also
with
a well—formed
inductive
proof
of
a
well-formed
expression this
of order
lemma
is
given
k. in
the
Annex.
T h i s lemma i s u s e d i n t h e p r o o f s o f t h e f o l l o w i n g t w o t h e o r e m s : THEOREM III.3a
p ^ S An
expression
non-operator non-operator
^qKp'^qcS
equiform expression expression.
is
with
a
well-formed
compound
also
a
well-formed
compound
110
CHAPTER in THEOREM
111.3b p e
An
expr0ssion
expression The
is
of
of
Theorems
omitted.
In
of
well-formsd
operator
of that
Convention
a
III.3a,b,
t h e inductive
therefore
view
with
a well—formed
quite similar t o t h e proof on t h e b a s i s
^ « j % p ^ < j € S .
equi/orm
also
proofs
S
operator
expression.
baised
on
Lemma
III.2,
lemma i n t h e c a s e s
assumption
II.3c,
2
ajid 3
( s e e Annex>. They
Conclusions
III.6
ar-e
and
are
II.2b
yield CONCLUSION
III.8
/>,qt Tfie
indices
of
e S ^ p % « j ^ a f e 6 .
ecfui form
well-formed
expressions
are
eqvt I form. We
shall
now
Definitions
formulate
II.6
and
c o n c e p t s : t h e set
B of
Jf and t h e set DEFINITION
F of
all
definitions
II.7.
They
al I basic fuTic tors
are
of that
set
well-formed index.
are
analo^a
definitions
expressions
of t h e
of
of two
co^language
language.
III.S
» - < p e S | a e / The
which
of
all
basic
expressions
expressions of
the
o is
oi—lang-aage
>. the
set
X which
of
all
have
those a
basic
THE THEORY OF TSC(D-L OF CATEGORIAL CD-LANGUAGES
111
DEFINITION III.6
The
sst
of
expressions
alt
of
a basic
functors
is
the oi-language
the
set
£ \eh.ich
of
have
all
veil-formed
an iTidex
that
is
not
index.
Definition
III.5,
Theorem
III.3,
Conclusion
III.8
and
Axiom
II.2 y i e l d THEOREM
111.3C
An expression basic
OQUiform
with
a basic
expression
is
also
a
expression.
Definition
III.6,
Theorem
III.3,
Conclusion
III.8,
Theorem
1.4 a and Axiom 1.7 y i e l d THEOREM Ill.Sd
An expression
equiform
The d e f i n i t i o n s
of
with
a functor
B and F make
it
is
also
a
functor.
possible
to
formulate
t h e o r e m which i s a n analog^on o f T h e o r e m II .4 i n TSCL. B e f o r e record
it
we
shall
first
draw
several
a we
conclusions
from
these
Definition
III.5
yield
definitions. Axiom immediately
III.4,
Theorem
the
following
C o n c l u s i o n 11.10:
III.2
and
conclusion
which
is
atnaloguous
to
112
CHAPTER III
CONCLUSION III.9 S"^ n B ^ 0.
7"ftere
is
a itel l-formed
t/ie ui-langriage
compo-und
£ u/tic/t. is
non-opsrator
a basic
expression
of
expression.
Axiom III.5, T h e o r e m IH.2 and Definit-ion IIl.S y i e l d CONCLUSION III.10
s'^ n B >' 0. There
is
a well-formed
operator
expression
which
is
a
basic
expression. Since,
by C o n c l u s i o n
expression,
auid,
expression
consists
three-element Conventions operator
by
III.10,
Definlt-ions of
an
concatenation III.2
whose
and index
there
11.2
of and
is
a
III.4
well-formed
aaid
operator
whose
indices,
by
Conclusion
belongs
to
III.l ,
each
Theorem
set
such
index
III.2 >
the
operator
is
I.13'S>
there
/\/
.
a <see
is
an
Thus,
by
C o n c l u s i o n III.7a and D e f i n i t i o n III.6, we h a v e CONCLUSION III.ll
O n F 7' 0. At
least
This
conclusion
assumption however,
one operator
that
is an
a cosequence
disjointness
of
of at
the o^-lang-uage variance
operator of
O £>nd F could,
adoption of a different
with
cannot
the here of
X is a func the
be
adopted course,
a
tor.
often
adopted
functor.
definition
of
be guaranteed
d e f i n i t i o n o f F, f o r i n s t a n c e
F • < p € S'SO I a € I\l
>. o
It
is,
F. The by t h e
THE THEORY OF TSCio-L OF CATEGORIAL o)-LANGUAGES
Since
S
is
Definitions
a
III.3
non-empty and
113
subset
III.2c,
of
S
Theorem
(Theorem
LIS^S)
and
III.2>,
by
Definition
III.6 w e a r r i v e a t CONCLUSION III.12
f S O ^ 0. There
is
a functor
la/tich.
is
not
a.n
operator.
We s h a l l r e c o r d o n e m o r e c o n c l u s i o n p e r t a i l n l n g t o f u n c t o r s . CONCLUSION III.13
° S n F i* 0. There
is
a simple
expression
of
the
U)-language
£ \ahich
is
a
functor. Conclusion be
proved
III.13
by
is
an
analo^on
reference
to
III.11-III.13
do
of
Conclusion
Conclusion
III.ll,
11.11.
Axiom
It
can
III.l
and
D e f i n i t i o n III.2a. Conclusions possibility follows hand,
from the
Conclusion III.6
of
and
including each
of
operators
them
that
non-emptiness III.9. Axiom
This, II.7
a n a l o g o n o f T h e o r e m II.4:
not,
of
of in
Definitions yield
the
F is B
course, set
preclude of
non-empty.
follows
immediately
functors. On t h e
Immediately
III.5, the
the
III.6,
It
other from
Conclusion
afore-mentioned
114
CHAPTER IH THEOREM
III.4
The
of
is
set
the
all
svan of
basic
well-formadi
two
expressions
ftinc
expressions
non-empty
and
of
language
that
of
disjoint
the
(ji-language
sets, and
that
that
of
of
all
all
its
other
than
tors. Note
t>^lal
Definition
If
we
adopt.ed
111.6 ^ i n s e r t e d
a
derinit.lon
earlier,
and
of
an
F
additional
(.CO>£7N/ , we could r e p l a c e T h e o r e m I1I.4 by t h e f o l l o w i n g The
set
is
the
sum of
of
all
basic
of
func tors, The
all
vtell—formed
three
and
that
<•)-language
of
all
£
that
syntactic
the
axiom: one:
i^-language
disjoint
language.
sets:
that
of
that
all
consideration
can
well-formed
be
split
in
this
The
set
into
syntactic
expression
S
belongs
we f o r m u l a t e
the
to
of
one
theorem
which
the
its
exactly
appropriate
that
a
categories
includes
states
is
all
T h e o r e m II.6a i n TSCL we n o t e t h a t
theorem
its
chapter
which i s a n a n a l o g o n o f the
£
operators.
language.
category. Before
of
pairwise
that
its
under
expressions
every
and
of
categorial
well-formed
expressions
non-empty
expressions
syntactically
so
X
TETk
relation
^
of
c
categorial
agreement
Conclusions
II.13a-c)
identify
syntactic
abstraction
of
and
an also
categories
that
Conclusion
III.6,
proved
reference
by
is
the
relation set to
E is the
equivalence the
theorem
with Csee
the
which
in
II.14>.
(eatrller
available
in
E
enables
appropriate
Conclusion
non-empty means
relation
that TSCL:
Csee us
to
classes
of
Since,
by
fact
was
Conclusion
THE THEORY OF TSCa>-L OF CATEGORIAL ti>-LANGUAGES
II.9d II.6
follows is
from
also
syntactic
a
by
determines
a
By
theorem
the
in
-. c
partition
of
categories
of
the
CtCB) of and of
family
those the
sets:
well-formed
the
all
basic
family
that
III.4,
family
of
of
course,
all
subset S,
B,
E. The
CtCS> of
of
of
of
E.
auid
F,
logical
oij-language J?,
functor of
also
syntactic
expressions
The definitions
E
following
all
the
aU
of
respectively,
expressions categories
of
partition
sets
are,
CtCFy of
language.
the
Theorem
Ct
non-empty
subsets
Ct
the
family
relation,
every
non-empty
II.9a,b>,
logical
That
are
the
The
a
TSC»*-L,
of
expressions
thus
Theorem
of
and
TSCw-L.
and
partitions
language,
is
II.6a,b
III.6
subfamilies
family
in
relation
logical
Conclusion
defined
Conclusions
categories
determined
115
of
caregories those
that of
concepts
are analoguous to Definitions Il.lla-c: DEFINITION III.7
a.
CtCS) = < C(
I f e t CS) >,
b.
CtCBy
m < Ct
I ^ e t,
c.
CtCF> = < Ct
I ? e UF? >.
The comments made above allow us t o formulate THEOREM
III.S.
c lassi fication well-formed categories their
The (logical
of
the
iiihich are non-empty,
consisting
of
B and
sum of
S.
Further,
the sum of all
"
parti tioJt)
expressions
sum ecfuals
the
relation
all
functor
determines of
the
set
(x>-language £ pairwise
5 can basic
be
of
all
syntac
tic
and such
presented equal
equal
logical
S
into
disjoint
categories
categories
a
to
as
that
the
sum
to
the
set
the
set
F.
116
CHAPTER III
Thus,
the following
"^*
conditions
ct,,ct''^tcs>
Clll)
U
av>
sm
m S,
^
u
c t u
Ct eCKBy
/undouiten t a { Those
Ct m B ^
and
II
of
the
ai-e
latter as
by in
by
of
the
is
we on
of
adopt
the
the
the
of
p.
In
TSCL, of
expression of the 00-language £.
of
of
Csee
is
It
the
order
fttsc and
obtained
constituent
Inductive
here
I
Sec.II.l
r
the
two
categories.
defining
the
n-th
of
abbreviations
expression
replacement
constituent
formulation syntactic
rCp/q> s , which denotes a
- f.
^
expression
expression
case
the
theory
read:
by the
the
the
expression
replacement
concluded
based
s
ct
Ct eCKPy
which
expression
ourselves, of
for
rCp^cfys, which
the
the
be
U
^
theor&ms of
fttsc,
Sec.II.7> from
will
theorems,
ct
Ct^tCPy
U
section
U
'
ct eCtCB> This
satisfiads
^^'j; ^ ^*a •* ^'? ^ ^ ^ - ^^'
Ct
ct sctcsy
are
we
avail
definition
relation
of
4
a
of
given
THE THEORY OF TSCtO-L OF CATEGORIAL (O-LANGUAGES DEFINITION
117
I1I.8
a.
r
eS/\<j%S/^p%r,
b.
rCpy^y
e S
- n>l
s ** Cs,r
^
s „ , » , , ' ' . . ,B € S <^»-P<«o'*l- ' V 0' 1 ' " --
" r-p
^
0
-^ «Q
%»
ys p * r^ /«. s
a: r
/N s
% r_> v C«j % s
/^ p % r
-^
^ 0
c.
At > 0 ^ CrCp/q>'''*'*s 4» j V ^ € r < v / 0 * s /^ v<.py
d.
r < p / q > s 4* V rCp/<j> s .
Definit.ions
III.8a,c,d
formulat.ions accordance from
the
as with
have
t.he
Definitions Definition
expression
s
ror-ms
II.14a,c,d,
111.8b
by t h e
saane
the
of
its
r
with
s
and r
a r e w e l l - f o r m e d compound n o n - o p e r a t o r
expansions
expressions
of
consisting the
of
(>>-language
with t h e same numbers o t h e r the
J-th
expression
the
of
the
X
that
same and
number
such
that
is
of
s
is
4
either expressions
of
well-formed
all
components
a c e r t a i n J a r e equiform,
exp2insion
In
obtatined
constituent
o f t h e f i r s t o r d e r by t h e e x p r e s s i o n p i f and only i f 1
verbal
respectively.
expression
replacement
and
equiform
with
and «j
118
CHAPTER III
and t-he J-i-h expression of t h e expansion of r Is equiform wlt-h p,
or 2° s and r a r e wel-formed o p e r a t o r e x p r e s s i o n s such t h a t one
of t h e t h r e e foUowlns conditions Is s a t i s f i e d : Ca) qf i s equiform with t h e main o p e r a t o r of s, p is with
the
main o p e r a t o r
of
r,
and
the
indexical
equiform
variaJsles
of
t h o s e o p e r a t o r s and t h e i r s c o p e s a r e equiform, Cb>
equiform
o p e r a t o r of s,
with
the
indexical
variable
of
the
main
p i s equiform with t h e indexical variable of
the
main o p e r a t o r of r, and t h e main o p e r a t o r s of s an r and t h e indexical
variables
and
the
scopes
of
those
operators
are
equiform, Cc>
s,
p i s equiform with t h e scope of t h e main o p e r a t o r of r, and t h e main
operators
of
s
and r
and
their
indexical
variables
are
equiform. Note t h a t
in t h e
aT& equiform those
with
case the
2 Cb) i f
the
corresponding
replaceable
indexical
variables a r e equiform. In such a c a s e
expressions
variables, s
and r
then
are,
by
III.8a-d
we
does
not
Conclusion III.3, equiform, t o o . Note can
also
arrive
that at
on
the
conclusions
strength whose
of
Definitions
symbolic
recording
differ from t h a t of Conclusions I1.20a,b, II.21-II.23. We now p a s s t o t h e two f t t s c which are e s s e n t i a l f o r TSC«*-L. Their graphic form does not differ from t h e two f t t s c TSCL CTheorems II.7a and I1.7b).
valid in
THE THEORY OF TSCo)-L OF CATEGORIAL avLANGUAGES
119
T H E O R E M I I I . 6 a CI f t t . s c > c
If
an expression
expression syntac
s
tic
of
to
The fttsc
p,
then
of
the
o^-lang^iage
language,
by
the same
proof
of
that
category,
an expression belong
r
the the
£
uhic/t
replacement
is
obtained
belongs
of
reploLceable
syntactic t.hls
c
its
to
from the
same
constituent
expressions
on
q by
p and q
also
category.
theorem,
modelled
after
t h e proof
of
I
I n S e c . I I . 7 , i s g i v e n i n t h e Annex.
THEOREM
III.6b r<.pyq')s
// an expression expression
s
constituent
q
syntac
tic
syntac
tic
The
r of
of
that
by
an
category
y - p i ^ q ^ r ^ s . c c
the
(ji-language
language
by
expression
as q,
£ the
obtained
replacement
p v>hich
then
is
belongs
r and s also
to
belong
to
from
an
of
its
the
same
the
same
category.
proof
of Theorem
III.6b can be easily
reconstructed if
we follow the proof of II fttsc given in Sec.II.7, and also the proof of Theorem III.6a. It is therefore omitted here. The two fttsc taken jointly enable us to prove T H E O R E M III.6
rCp/qJs -> Cp » Q •» r « s>. Two syntactic in
expressions category
a rtiell-formed
well-formed
of if
the
and only
expression
expression
of
if of
that
by replac the
£
belong
the
same
ing one by the
other
ij>-language
language
which
to
£
we obtain
belongs
to
a the
120
CHAPTER III
saume syntac
Sec
tic
category
III.6.
as
ths
T h e SLlgorithm o f c h e c k i n e t h e cor-recloess of
The
algor-it.hm
expressions given
in
of
t.o
the
Sec.II.8
be
and
preliminary
CO-language
label c o n s i s t s
able,
referring
t w o . We a l s o is
index,
in
whether
expression. position of
its
to
one of
It
If
is
it
arguments
of
categorial
index
that to
similar
the
to
compound
them
an is
chapter,
Sec.II.8.
We
number
are is
t.o
compound
the
algorithm
expressions
of
which p a r t s
functor. every
expansion
of
the
assume
of
that
to
it
symbols, decide and
of it We
about is
or
compound
of
the
a
a
about about
a concatenation
operator,
parts
of
an
eqvilform
whether
part
symbolism
accordingly
we c a n d e c i d e
a
the
are
criteria,
they
which
which
pert.alns
concerning
finite
that
establish
and
a
vocabulary,
expansion,
functor,
in
not,
assume
the
It. i s to
this
empirical
or
labels, whether
it
in
of
to
here
language.
formulated
whether
£.
assumptions
every
laibels
described
pertaining
Jf, a n a l y s e d
assumptions
synt.act.tc
expressions
OJ-language
any s i m p l e c a t e g o r i a l The
latter.
of
it
it
expression
a l s o a s s u m e t h a t a b o u t any s e q u e n c e o f
two three
remaining whether
word
that
has
variable,
or we
correspond
to
corresponds
to
also of
any
label
correspond are
are
any
expression,
of
we
any
the
that
the
Indices
to able
the to
a
an
compound
are the
in
a
words
the
main
successive assign
o>-language
X.
a We
THE THEORY OF TSCci>-L OF CATEGORIAL w-LANGUAGES
12'
we can decide whether it. sat.isfles the condition
where a i s the index of the expression p. We
ailso
retain
the
term
compound expression". Let
"intermediate
vis recall
that
expansion
the
sequence
and
only
of
a
> i s
an
intermediate expansion of the expression
such
that
Pf.>P^t—rp are
such
that
0
f .
expressions
s: a.
and
a. .
if is
the
if
index
for
of
any
the
i
i-th
element of the expansion of C6>. Thds
if
a
compound
expression
of
the
co-languaige
£
is
an
operator expression of the form f*
>
P
then,
in
accordance
III.l ,
the
with
intermediate
the
convention
expansion
of
adopted
(.6 >
is
and
any
Definition
sequence
of
indices
such t h a t for any i, The
ailgorithm
compound auxiliary
0
of
expression
checking of
algorithm, namely
expression operations
Csee of
that
Sec.II.8>.
the
where a. syntactic
the
ci>-language
that
of
In
» (.Cp.5. correctness
£
begins
cons tr-uc ting
carrying
algorithm we find
out
whether
trse the
tree
of
with I of
a an
that
successive I of
a given
122
CHAPTER III
compound e x p r e s s i o n i s , o r i s not,, a t-ree o f arranged
expression.
•we o r d e r
the
elements
Sec.II.8,
and
that
checking
of
If
next
the
order
that
we
pass
to
the
existence
with
that
whether
at
operator.
If
is
question,
which
this
included
in
the
is
languages
we
Sec.II.8.
If,
of
I of
tree
transform
not
of
the
In
underline the
then
described
algorithm,
the
of
namely in
upon
it
we
all
check,
in
the expression
in
first
tree of
I of
its
final
then
the
and
nodes
is
an
expression
in
does
not,
since
oo-language
simple
to
of
well-arranged,
the
contrary,
I of
that
order
it
J? which
operations
at
one
least
of
in q u e s t i o n ;
be
categorial
described
the
tree
can
final
I' by
in
nodes
then
we
proceeding
directives;
for
which
into
of
satisfies
syntactically
further
expression
fixed
variables
expression
in
operators
t h e e x p r e s s i o n i n q u e s t i o n i s an o p e r a t o r ,
tree
all
afflrmat-ive,
binding
operators,
in accordance with t h e following 1
well-
manner
•uoidly
case,
binding
imposed
the
one
thoroughly
submit
on
t-he
successive
algorithm
fragment
conditions
in
in t h e
the
leaist
voldly
that
tree
the elements of
question,
include
is
thoroxigh.ly
consideration.
fixed for
course,
answer
of
t h e e x p r e s s i o n under In a c c o r d a n c e
t-he
a
the
aure t h e those
elements final
of
tree
nodes
of
are
their
variables
tree
I
we
I,
of
own
free
variables. 2
Once we know all
underlined,
in
the
binding o p e r a t o r s transformation,
the
free
successive -
we
in t h e find,
variables
expression
*-th while
line of
-
which o c c u r , which
tree
observing
have
I being
the
order
and no
voidly
subject from
are
to the
THE THEORY OF TSCtO-L OF CATEGORIAL(i>-LANGUAGES
123
left, i^o t.he rights, whet,her in any compound expression p in t-he A-l-t-h
Une
binding
situated
operator,
above
and
in
we
that,
tree
establish
there
what
is
a
possible
voidly further
o p e r a t i o n s should be made in trainsformins t r e e I. Ca> If t h e main functor of p i s not an o p e r a t o r , t h e n p does not
include
a
voidly
binding
operator.
Then in
every
part
of
t h a t e x p r e s s i o n which corresponds t o t h e component p.
Ci>0) of
the
which
expansion
of
equiform
with
syntactic
position
expression
is
p we underline
the
free in t h a t
equiform
every
variadsle
that
expression
with
p..
such
of
The
variable
occupies the
A-th
variables
is
the
same
line,
which
underlined
In
t h a t manner are all f r e e varistbles in p. If t h e main functor of p i s an operator expansion in t h e sequence p_,p^,p_, then in t h e occur
expressions
equiform,
aind p has fc-th
line
its
there
respectively,
with
p„,p ,/>^ and such t h a t e i t h e r Cb > «j
is
not
eqviiform
with
any
free
variable
in
q
or
t h e r e i s no f r e e variable in tf , or Cb > qf, i s equiform with a variable q In t h e tree
I'
caseCb > t h e of
the
operator
expression
which i s f r e e in q .
p„ in p i s
under
voidly binding
consideration
has
and been
constructed. In t h e c a s e Cb„) t h e o p e r a t o r p^ in p binds a variable which is
eqxiiform
with
the
variable
Then p has no voidly binding part
of
variable
p
which
which i s
corresponds equiform
q
and i s
operators. to
with
p a
we free
within In t h a t
its case
underline variable
scope
in
p^.
in
that
every
such
q ,
other
124
CHAPTER HI
t.Kan cf^, which has
t,he
same
synt.act
posit.ion.
The
vai^iables
underlined in p are all f r e e variables in p. 3°
The
construcMon
carrying
operations
operator
or
expression
of
1
tree
and 2 ,
we reach t h e
1'
we
first
under consideration,
is
terminated
encounter
line of
a
tree
when,
voidly
in
binding
I, which i s
and find t h a t
it
has no
the
voidly
binding operator. If in t r e e I' of t h e e x p r e s s i o n under consideration t h e r e an
element
algorithm has
which
of
been
well-formed. which
successive
checking
the
completed:
the
If
has
includes
no
a
expression
I' proves
voidly
binding of
binding
well-formedness
tree
operations
voidly
to
in
be a
operator,
checking
of
the
operator that
the
expression
question
is
t^ee
of
an
then
we
pass
syntactic
is
not
expression to
correctness
the of
t h a t expression. For
that
elements their
purpose,
of
tree
categorlal
catsgorial
I
in we
indices.
indices
accordance successively We obtsdn
of
a
given
tree
will
be
termed
Sec.II.8,
we
proceed
Sec.II.8>. That
with
the
fixed
replace in
this
its way
compound tree
II
order
of
elements
by
the
tree
expression of
the
of <see
expression
being checked. As
in
expansions p a r t s of
of
the
to
order
compound e x p r e s s i o n s
t r e e II. Out of
of
two intermediate
the tree
intermediate I,
formed
expansions t h a t
of one
i s t h e eourlier which i s an intermediate expansion of an e a r l i e r element of t r e e I. The
description
of
the
last
part
of
the
algorithm
of
THE THEORY OF TSC(D-L OF CATEGORIALW-LANGUAGES
checking
the
compound
well-formedness
expression does
Sec.II.8.
accordance
In
expansions which
is
we an
not
with
check
which
Rt . P
of
does
checking
When
not
the
we
I,
find
satisfy
being
intermediate
expansion
the
tree
syntactic
the
for
well-formedness
the
the
indices
examples
not
which
(including elements form,
a
main of
as
before
tree
equiform
is
forms}
that
equlfoi-m
To
of
the
indices the
index
of
a
s/ns,
and
to
has
the
the
functors which
are
occurs
expression occur
after
airguments o f
which that that
an i n d e x w h i c h
quantifier
the
I
been
of
which
which
h a s an i n d e x n we a c c o r d i n g l y with
tree
quasi-fractional
index
assign
the
checking
main
linear
successive
the
well-formed.
the
which
we
of
expressions
The
index o f
expression
the
the
Sec.II.8.
the
indices
in
p of
question
of
of
If
concatenations
compound
in
indicates
the
s.
indices
written
To a s e n t e n t i a l with
the of
case
/
functor
name v a r i a b l e which
are
the
slant
symbol i n d i c a t e functor.
I
the
to
operators)
was
the
given
correspond
below
the
completed:
algorithm in
which
algorithm
expression
the
p
expansion
well-formed.
expression
given
II
p satisfy
the
completed, too: t h e e x p r e s s i o n being checked i s In
tree
been
in
expression
of
m
has
then
given
intermediate
compound
condition, of
parts
binding
intermediate
compound
first
is
any
for
the expression
correctness
of
desired
any
condition
checked
voidly
description
adopted
those
the
the
well-arranged
include
the
order
expansion of
expression
satisfies
the
thoroughly
not
from
whether,
element
a
does
differ
f o r m thfc i n t e r m e d i a t e condition
of
which
operators
125
index
binds
assign of
a
a
is a
label
quantifier
126
CHAPTER III
which
binds
equiform the
of
of
in
a
contains
it
is
a
a
is
sentential
name
variable
variable
sentential
it
variable
of
and
variable
functor
the
and
a
a
a
free
of
that-
second
a
that
is
a is
functor
which
expression
which
it
about
the
second
it
is
the is
in
forms
together
expression
it.
arguments,
free
which
in
which
variable
sentential
functor
is
say
the
name
say
sentential
which
and
is
label
two
index
that we
a we
of
a
is
Likewise,
index
label
contains
nsane
the
assign
variable,
words,
expression.
we
former
name which
other
that
sentential
the
sentence-forming
In
with
variable
About,
expression
it.
together
that
s/ss.
which
sentential free
sent.ent.lal
wit-h
index
first
a
that
forms
a
label
with
a
contains
a
a
sentential
expression. The
above
possible which
to
are
description
bring
out
operators
of
the and
the
indices
specific to
of
operators
character
distinguish
of
them
makes
those
it
functors
from
"ordinary"
of
checking
functors. We
shall
now
well-formedness the
recording
their
are
apply
to of
three
those
ordinarily
E x a m p l e correctness
of
algorithm
compound
arithmetical
expressions
we
use
expressions.
brackets
In
the
In way
used.
III.l. the
this
We
shall
first
check
the
syntactic
is
thoroughly
expression
Cnl>
/^ V X > y .
y y In
order
well-arranged
to
find we
whether construct
the
expression
tree
I
of
Cnl> that
expression
THE THEORY OF TSCa>-L OF CATEGORIAL Ci>-LANGUAGES
CFlg.III.lJ.
All
expressions,
terminal and
accordingly
nodes
hence
transform
127
or Is
tree
I
tree
thoroughly
into
i n c l u d e s v o i d l y binding o p e r a t o r s
that,
tree
(see
are
simple
well-arranged.
I'
and
see
We
if
Cnl>
in
the
Fig.III.1>,
.'^A
> Fig.III.l. Note
that
expression equlform quantifier because second
the
in
variable
in
the
first
place
variable is
which
expression
the
not
line y.
line
which
in
binds
variable
contrary,
of
the
tree
occurs
in
with
that
Let
a
occurs
the
us
the
any
line
being checked i s n o t 111.2.
which
On
equlform
occurs
in
the
is
the
is
universal
voidly
second
free
which
binding
line
in
the
variable
in
the
third
place.
Hence
well-formed.
check
now
the
well-formedness
expression
Cfi2>
A V X + Cy • « ) X y
We can
quantifier
second
the
E x a m p l e of
existential
the
" y
I' o f t h e e x p r e s s i o n Cnl)
with
the
expression
the
Tree
o x
be
construct seen
tree
that
I and
the
then
expression
tree
I'
being
of
Cn2>
checked
<:Fig.III.2>. It is
thoroughly
128
CHAPTER in
well-arranged must,
and
accordingly
does construct,
compound
expression
form
int^ermediat.e
t.he
not.
include tree
p of
tree
voldly
II I
of
of
operat^ors.
C7i2> and s e e
t.hose
expansion
binding
part.s
of
p sat.isfy
if
for
t-ree
t-he
We any
II
which
condit.ion
m .
T r e e II o f C7T2> i s s h o w n i n Fig.III.3. Those form
part.s
the
the
tree
intermediate
of
third
the line
of
that
'"vv-i-r expression
expression
and,
vairiable
that
of
which
expansion
condition which
compound e x p r e s s i o n condition
II
m
•>*
^^e
is
not
with
index
Pig.III.2.
intermediate
of
the
the
the the
index index
the of
of
and with
indices
expansion
the
well-formed.
y
T r e e I' o f t h e e x p r e s s i o n
a the
quantifier
index o f
its
of
satisfy
existential of
line
equiform
contrary,
a concatenation
and
second
^ x+
t h e e x p r e s s i o n being checked i s not
jc
its
an e x p r e s s i o n
the
successively, quantifier
of
in
. On t h e
form
equiform
occur
that
indexical
scope.
Hence
129
THE THEORY OF TSCoJ-L OF CATEGORIAL CD-LANGUAGES
T»XnT»
Flg.III.S. E x a m p l e correctness
of
Tree
II o f
III .3. the
We
the
first
construct
thoroughly
expression
shall
X
has • the
n
check
now
the
syntactic
expression
<;TI3>
which
-
functor tree
of
Implication
I of
well-arranged.
y as
that We
•'
as
expression accordingly
'
Its
main
functor.
and f i n d t h a t transform
We
CrrS) I s
tree
I
of
t h a t e x p r e s s i o n I n t o I' Csee Flg.III.4). The Is
operator
equiform
operator.
expression
with
The
^
x+v<2
two
line
of
tree
^
and
^
^
operators.
Hence
does
Include
not
therefore,
I'
x+y
perform
does
operator
second x>0
which
is
and
not
are, do only
voidly
binding
the
successive
In
the
include
expressions
also not
occurs
any
which
third
line
voidly occur
binding In
respectively,
equiform
not
voidly
include
thoroughly operators, operations
of
the with
binding
well-arrau-iged either.
and
We
checking
but must, the
130
CHAPTER III
well-formedness
of
fche
expression
under
consideration.
For
that
p u r p o s e we c o n s t r u c t t r e e II o f Cn3>
accordance
with
expansions
we
expression
p
of
determined
by
parts
the
check,
order
established
successively,
tree of
I
the
tree
II
whether
for for
expressions
Cn3> i s a w e l l - f o r m e d
of
tree
I
any
expansion
of
p
satisfies
condition
tn .
It
the
satisfies
that
expamsions of condition.
expression.
o ^ x>0 ^ /N V x + y < 2 ' S^ y z - ^
Fig.III.4.
compound
Intermediate
turns out t h a t each of the seven Intermediate compound
Intermediate
T r e e I' o f t h e e x p r e s s i o n Cn3>
the
Hence
131
THE THEORY OF TSCOJ-L OF CATEGORIAL lo-LANGUAGES
Fig.III.S.
Tree
II o f
s/n/i
", 71
Tiynn
on
t-he e x p r e s s i o n
CrrSJ
on
*> n
CHAPTER
IV
DUAL THEORIES
S e c . IV.l.
The d o u b l e ont.ologicad. ctvaract.er o f
lincui8t.lc
o b j e c t s and I h e b i a a p e c t u a l apppoacti t o l a n g u a g e
Thei<e t-he
atre
t.erm
discrepancies
"lan(;ua|;e".
understanding;
of
expression.
and
They
such
from
expressions
are
well
G.S.Pelrce as
t.he
semiotlc related
linguistic
Particularly
originating
in
to
the
components known
and
as
is
C1931-353,
to/tens
lnt.erppet.at.lon
as
ambiguous label,
the
between typos
of
word,
distinction, laheis,
Calso:
words,
events
and
d e s i g n s , L a t . i n c o n c r e t o a n d In s p e c i e ) . Tok»ns
are
entitles
concrete
which
are
material
classes
of
tokens.
linguistic
objects,
belonging
categories,
are
Independently
semlotlc and
and
logic
objects
we
logical refer,
and t o
analyses Csee
used
[19671),
expressions
in in
the
hand,
meaning,
truth,
with
the
as
the
is
expressions,
functioning
of
denotation, 132
and
abstract kinds
different
to
of
ontological
instruments
becaiise
of
in
semiotics
concrete
linguistic
Instance,
connected
contexts
reference,
so
functional is
are two
convenient
footing, For
typos These
two
This
equal
which
concrete
to
objects.
definite
interested other
an
aJ^stract
concerned
J.Pelc
analysis. on
objects,
In t h e
approach with
pragmatic
to the
situations,
i.e.,
expression
such
semlotlc
communication
language use
of
we
are
tokens.
On
concepts
as
process
is
DUAL THEORIES
133 (ZS)
based
on
t.he
linguistic
concept, of
product.
equlphonlc
expression
which
expression
is
the
tokens.
t.ype
class Such
of
expressions
clearly, in the contemporary analysis. The of
graphic
can
always
Many
labels,
words,
context
that
authors
do
expressions, they
refer
to
interpretation
of
more
whether
explain though
them
as
or
with
as
an
less
language
expression
understood
not
even
or
concerned
abstraction of expression tokens determined equiformity.
equiform
seen,
literature
are
all
abs'tract
natural of all. Such
be
doubt, however, arises languages
of
an
expression types seems to be the most interpretation
, i.e., an
types
classes
of
by the relation of how
it
they
interpret
follows
types
from
the
without,
however,
"label",
"word",
making use of such concepts as equiformity. This
duality
In
"expression" does not language.
Theoretical
literature
of
take
account
into
the
using impose
the any
terms
definite
constructions
subject that
and
logical conception
encountered
pertaining
aspect
of
to
language
in
language which
of the
usually
makes
It
possible to speak about its expressions as types. In the preceding three chapters we have been interested in a different point of view. We have been concerned with the formal determination and
of
expression
components concrete
of
the
properties
tokens
of
languages,
objects,
that
of
label tokens, word
graphic
languages.
being
perceivable
is, tokens.
The
These by
theories
tokens,
syntactic sight
TLTk,
are TETk,
TSCL, TSC««r-L thus describe language as a product of a different kind, as a language of expression tokens.
134
CHAPTER IV
The t.he
double
double
analysis
ont.ologlcal
way
of
speak,
chaj>act.ei>
making
use
however,
of
If
not. want, t-o b r e a k
one
does
should of
language
not. c o n f i n e
expression
tokens
only.
single
theoretical
have
Both
precedents
also
in
the
Jerzy
as
of
the
whose the
object
indirectly,
as of
be
can
t.he
be
and
words,
by
G.Bryll
chapter
we
inquiry
they
said
outline
is
that
take
into
biaspectual
S.Miklos
in
several the
of
namely
the
TLTp,
four TETp,
extension
of
preceding
chapters.
definitional theory the of the
the
account,
approach
DTSCL,
Thus,
directly
to
of
and
TSCLj
and
of or
syntactically dual.
in
DTSC**-L,
theory
this is
discussed
in
chapter,
definitional one
of
the
theory
TLTp of
label
types
the
theory
TLTk
label
tokens;
the
definitional
extension
of
; the
theory
types
expression
categorial
analysed
theories
the
expression
t h e o r y TETk o f
theory
theories
corresponding
extension
TETp of
simple
dual
by
119771;
description
c a t e g o r i a l l a n g u a g e s . T h e s e t h e o r i e s will b e t e r m e d Each
inspired
axiomatic.
shall
feature
a
algorithms
abstract
and
in
We
and
presented
expression
attained.
of
concrete
one
language
reflected
of
specific
the
should
aspect.s.
pract-lce
119541 t h e o r y
and
of
semiot.ic
language
goal
t-heoretlcal
double
language
language That
it.s
and
llnsuist.ic
such
A.A.Markov's
present
principal
from
obJect,s
log^ical
of
the
t h e l a t t e r , unlike Markov's t h e o r y , i s In
In
explain
away
conception.
theory
Slupecki
could
or
auspects
in
Ihem
t.o t . r e a t . l n g
only
Un(;uist.ic
favour
which
oneself
types
of
in
concept.lons
of
is
a
tokens
languages
is
the
theory
dual
a
of
dxial
definitional DTSC«»-L
is
DTSCL
extension of
a
of
categorial
DUAL THEORIES
135
ui-lang'u.ages The
i s a d e f i n i t . i o n a l e x t ^ e n s i o n o f t h e ' t h e o r y TSC«»-L.
definitions
which
are
added
TSCL a n d TSC«»-L t o p r o d u c e t h e It
possible
to
characterized
look by
at
to
theories
corresponding
language
the
the
not
ordered
TLTk,
TETk,
duatl t h e o r i e s
as
a
sixtuple
product
Csee
make
earlier
Sec.I.l
and
Sec.II.l> < Lb;
<£->
V, W; %, C; S >,
but as a product whose syntactic characteristic is described by the ordered sixtuple < IE;
C£->
consisting
of
vocabulary
V of
the
the
relation
The
sets
equiformity of
equiformity is
holds
the
etfuali
Lb,
of
V,
Lh
types,
of
a.X.X label
tfie
ty
and
W,
^/-^> the
in
the
S
are
'•'/-o.'
set
W of
Lb, set
the S
abstraction
any
Lb,
of
label
three-au>gument
V,
W, of
Cequlvalence by
relation
label
t.hat
element
%, d e t e r m i n e d ordinary
defined
^Z—*
sets
%. H e n c e
between
abstraction a
of
Lb,
Lb^^^
quotients
•
iiiord
set
types,
all
word
types,
relation
of
the
c
all
of
ttell-formed
types.
families
class
unlversad
in
expression
W; -, C; S >,
simple "
concatenation
V,
a
types, tokens.
Cternaur-y?
respective
is
as
S
by
each
class>
given
of
as
The
is,
relation
relation
the
relation
of
the
of
sets
The
equality
of
is
a of
relation sets.
classes
concatenation holds
of
relation
token.
between
which
respective
those
extensional that
the
of
label
quotient
between
It of
C
is
label
136
CHAPTER IV
types. The
concepts
respectively, defined
to
Lb, the
V,
W,
concepts
and
Lb,
c,
V,
in TLTp CSec.IV.2>. We s h a l l
which
W, and
correspond,
C in
demonstrate
TLTk.,
that
In
one can r e p r o d u c e - If a c e r t a i n a s s u m p t i o n i s made axioms a
of
Tarski's
concept
which
C1933] m e t a s c i e n c e
is
defined
<Sec.IV.3>.
separately
in DTSC«»-L CSec.IV.6). The l a s t
in
The
are TLTp
all
set
the S
DTSCL <Sec.IV.5>
two dual t h e o r i e s
are
the latter primitive the
by t h e adding t o i t and s e c o n d a r y
definition
that
set.
followinif
of
We
here
concepts: t h e
s e t I of a l l abatTCLct indices
of
expression
vord
/ , the It
is
set
above
all
Z
btisxc
of
indices, the
function
that
the
quotients
%, and t h a t
determined
by
the
t,
sets of
basic
the
definitions
relation E of
L of of
function
T , o
/, I
E ,E
t/ie
forming
compound
types. of
by
classes
These the
p , and t h e
are
the
indicating
the
of
set
set
defined
as
€. the
relation
t h e a r g u m e n t s of t h e r e l a t i o n appropriate
of
of
the
concepts
the
introduce
indices,
expression the
from
properties
aJbstTtxct
p all
/ ,
to
the
t h e r»la.tio7%
on
of all analoga of
TETk, needed
determine
and t h e set
/, the
corresponding
are
of
analoga, r e s p e c t i v e l y , of
natural
equlformity
set
types,
types,
concepts a r e
concepts
S and t o
meaun
of d e f i n i t i o n s
and
based
TETp CSec.IV.4), which i s t u r n based on TETk and o b t a i n e d
is
t and
abstraction
of p of
label t o k e n s . Generally
speaking,
te, each p r i m i t i v e definitional
or
extension
except defined yields
for
the
concept
concept
of
one
the
of
of
a given dual
the
relation
theory,
whose
theories
under
DUAL THEORIES
137
consideration, concept the
in
that,
d e n o t e d by t h e
term
line
has
denoting
placed
given
the
aJ>ove
dual
corresponding
theory
Its
t e r m which d i f f e r s concept
that
theory
dual
that
Each
such
be
said
to
Cterm)
of
to
theory
term.
will
concept
in
as
analogon its
be
the
the
shape
by t h e
concept
In
from
horizontal
tterm)
indvcod
of
by
corresponding
a the
original
theory. In next
the to
dual the
described consider
simple
by
the
the
described
theory
categorial
system
simple
by
DTSCL, w h i c h
the
is
superstructured
language
CJf > C s e e
categorial
X
Sec.II.1),
language
following
of
system
on
expression we
J? o f
will
TSCL., tokens,
be
able
expression
consisting
to
types,
of
concepts
an
extension
i n d u c e d b y t h e c o n c e p t s o f Cjf ): CJf >
< Lb;
V, V; - ; c ; Z , 7 ; I , p ; E, S , C t C S ) >.
c
o
Likewise,
in
the
dual
theory
DTSC«*-L,
o f TSC«»-L, n e x t t o t h e (oi-Jf c ) <see Sec.III.l>,
w-languaige we shall
categorial
£,
following of
o>-language system
consisting
d e s c r i b e d by be concerned
described of
is
the system with the
syntactically
concepts
Induced
by
by t h e
the
concepts
Cco-Jf >: c
Cco-^ > < i 6 ; V, VT,
In
every
properties
O, W; - ; C ; 7 , 7 ; 7 , p , C / v ) ; £ , S,
dual
of
the
theory
serving
as
its
the
concepts
initial theory pertaining and
£
which
theorems
induced
by
which the
establish
concepts
to the languages of expression
foundation, will hold. Those
be syntactical analoga
CTCS:».
of
the
corresponding
of
the the
tokens
theorems
will
axioms, definitions
138
CHAPTER IV
and
theorems
by
the
Initial
of
the
initial
appropriate theory.
concept
of
an
What
definitions,
does
mean?
it
expression
expression
called
aiicioms,
defined in a r i g o r o u s given
theory,
induced
a
mainner. B u t t o
and
the
and
For
by
expressions theorems
every given
TSCL, TSC«»-L, and
Let let
T be
DT be
etny
induced
of
the
by
it
dual
T.
tf>^n (p is
theory
the
can
be
theory
it
a
suffices
rigorous:
theories
the
the
analogy b e t w e e n
t o a d o p t a g e n e r a l d e f i n i t i o n , which i s n o t v e r y DEFINITION IV.
dual
of
expression
show t h e
expression
induced
TLTk,
obtained
TETk,
from
the
latter. 1/
induced
an expression
in
by 4> ^f caxd- only
replacement
in
Ca) of
the
Cb) of
other
the
latter
term
% by
if
(p is
obtained
in every the
constant
DT a n
from
expression the
correct
place
symbol terms
in
", of
T by
the
terms
induced
by
them, Cc> of by
the
the
variables
Cd> of variables An dual
letter
the
ranging,
theory
a
over
ranging the
expression version
ranging
respectively,
variables
ranging induced
variables
family has
which
t h e e x p r e s s i o n by w h i c h i t i s Before
we
proceed
to
DTSCL, DTSCur-L we a d o p t
in is
the
sets
Lb,
over
the
sets
Lb,
the
family
2
J, I,
E E,
by
the
in
the
2 its quite
verbal
formulation
similar
to
the
version
of
induced.
outline the
over
over
the
dual
convention,
as
theories in c a s e
TLTp, of
TETp,
previous
DUAL THEORIES
139
c h a p t ^ e r s , s t - a t - i n ^ t.ttat. C o n v e n t i o n whose
numbers
are
IV.l.
marked
m e t a t h e o r y of a given In
constructing
theory
we
dvial
The
concepts
Caccepted
asterisk,
are
sentences)
theses
of
the
as
the
an
extension
conventions
of
a
applied
given
at
the
theory.
T h e t h e o r y TLTp o f l a b e l t y p e s
theory
TLTk o f
an
theory
observe
p r e s e n t a t i o n of t h a t given
S e c . IV.2.
with
theses
theory.
a
shall
The
TLTp o f
label t o k e n s induced
label
types
by a d d i n g
by
the
to
is
obtained
the
primitive
former
and
from
the
theory
definitions
of
the
concepts
of
the
derived
latter. THEOREM IV.l . a th»sis
of
This this It
Every
thesis
Caccepted
sentenced
of
TLTk
is
occasions
later
in
of
TLTp.
theorem
will b e
referred
to
on
many
of
TLTk
chapter. follows
from
equiformity
is
accordingly
produce
relation.
The
determined will b e
an
by
Axioms
equivalence classes
class the
denoted
by
/L6/_ C t h e q u o t i e n t
I.la-c
of
relation of
that
the
relation
the
set
Lb.
in
abstraction
abstraction
of
relative the
We to
token
p (representative
of
F f
1 • A^
^^
^^
quotient
i6
by t h e
of
the
set
known,
the
relation
that
relation
label
that
*) is
can
%,
claiss), family the
set
140
of
CHAPTER IV
all
classes
represent.at.ives
of
abst.ract.lon
are
definite
label t y p e s Is defined DEFINITION
of
label
t-he
t.okens.
relat.lon The
%
set
whose
Lb
of
all
thus:
IV.l
,
Lb m Lb/^
w h i c h c a n b e r e p l a c e d by CONCLUSION
IV.l
p e I F «• V p _ [ p ] . A label determined,
type is
the
class
by a certain
of
label
abstrac
tion
of
the
relation
%.
token.
We adopt the following convention Csee Convention I.la>: C o n v e n t i o n p, <j, T, s,
IV.2a.
The symbols
t, %i, V, with or without subscripts,
range over the set Lb. The
expressions
respectively,
that
induced
the
relation
by
Axioms
of
equality
I.la-c "
is
state, reflexive,
symmetric, and transitive in Lb. W e accordingly have THEOREM TLTk are The
IV.2 . theorems
The in
expressions
by
Axioms
I.la-c
of
TLTp.
three-argument
defined thus:
induced
relation
of
concatenation
in
Lb
is
DUAL THEORIES
141
DEFINITION
IV.2
c<:p,5,r> • • p ^ ^ J. *^P • J4 l<xb«l if
and
tho
tyf>& r
only i /
relatioTX
is
[p]
-^ 5 -
[Q] ^ r -
t/ie c o n c a t e n a t i o n of
t/ie t a & e l s p . g .
of
l<xbel
types
r a r e c l a s s e s of
% sucA. t/iat a ropresontative
concatsnation
[ r ] /v cCp,Q,r)).
rspr»ssntatives
of
of
abstraction
the
tA.e classes
p and q
class
o/
r is
p and
th.&
q.
D e f i n i t i o n IV.2 c a n b e r e p l a c e d by CONCLUSION
IV.2
p •« [ p ] A Q which
follows
[ q ] /s r •
from
t-his
[ r ] "• tcCp,^,F> *^ c
definition
aund
Theorem
I.l
and
Axiom
1.7. It can be d e m o n s t r a t e d t h a t c i s a two-argument
operation
in
Lb. In f a c t , t h e e x p r e s s i o n i n d u c e d by Axiom 1.2, namely THEOREM
IV.l
V
c(p,Q,r>
r i s a t h e o r e m i n TLTp. If
p
and
Conclusion p " [Pil there is
and
Convention
tokens
it
any
have
if
we
that
there
label
label
C Cp,qi, fr T >,
IV.2a, assume
follows
are
types,
then
it
follows
from
p^ and a. s u c h t h a t 1 1 ^^'i 9 " E'^il' ^^ a l s o f o l l o w s f r o m Axiom 1.2 t h a t a laJ^el t o k e n r^ s u c h t h a t CCp. ,q, , r . ) . By C o n c l u s i o n 1 1 1 1
we
then
are
IV.l t h a t
IV.2
Further,
<j
from
Pi''*!'*!'*"!'*!'^!
we that
tokens
from
which,
by
Conclusion
immediately
arrive
at
Theorem
CCp,q,t>,
Definition ="*=*^
cCr,s,Ti5
IV.2
*'^^*-
that ^[^i]'
and
p"r
there
IV.l IV.l.
and <j™s, are
^ [^^i]'
label ^"['i]'
142
CHAPTER IV
r»[rj, q s» .
^-[sj], This
^"["j]'
and
Axiom
cCp^,<j^,r^>, 1.4
yield
c
that.
t Jteu ,
Pj^^^i
which
in
^^'^ turn
y i e l d s t h e e q u a l i t y t"H. Hence we h a v e THEOREM
IV.2
C
is
induced
by
Axiom
1.4.
From
Theorems
"^i, IV.1
and
IV.2
we
at
CONCLUSION IV.2a
c: IbxLb —+ TS. The relation
c is
a two-argwnent
operation
in t6.
The v a l u e o f t h e f u n c t i o n c f o r t h e a r g u m e n t s p and q c a n be s y m b o l i z e d by p <j by a d o p t i n g <•>
that
r « p qi «•
c
W e shall however abandon here this notation for the value of the function C because our intention is to demonstrate that the expressions
induced
by
the
axioms
and
theorems
of
TLTk
are
theorems in TLTp. In view of Definition IV.2 and
the properties of the classes
of abstraction
[p] - [9] •• P == 9 we easily arrive at the following THEOREM of
TUTk are The
Expressions
IV.2 b. theorems
theorem
in
which
induced
by
Axioms
1.3,
I.
6-1.8
can,
with
TLTp. is
induced
by
Axiom
1.5
DUAL THEORIES
143
r e f e r e n c e t o t h e f o r m u l a <*>, b e r e c o r d e d i n t h e s i m p l e r
form
Cp qf> r • p <<j r ) . This
theorem
states
that
the
relation
of
concatenation
a n a s s o c i a t i v e o p e r a t i o n i n t h e s e t Lb o f a l l l a b e l The vocabulary DEFINITION
V of
simple
word
types
c
is
types.
is defined
thus:
IV.3
This d e f i n i t i o n c a n be r e p l a c e d by CONCLUSION
IV.3
P ^^ p
is
abstrac
a
simple
tion
cer tain
uwrd
of
simple
^ p^ir^'
type
the
relation
word
token.
if
W
and
of
only
if
etfui fortuity
p
is
a
class
determined
of by
a
C o n c l u s i o n s IV.l a n d IV.3 a n d Axiom 1.9 y i e l d THEOREM
IV.3
0 * V S which
is
an
easily
obtain
expression
THEOREM I V . 2 C. are
theorems The s e t
in
induced
Expressions
by
Lb, Axiom
induced
IV.4
of
Axioms
TLTp.
W of all word t y p e s i s defined
DEFINITION
by
1.9
thus:
TLTk.
I.10
We
and
also
1.11
144
CHAPTER IV
which c a n b e r e p l a c e d by CONCLOSION I V . 4
of
p is
a word
the
relation
t y p e if of
and only
if
eQvifoTmity
"p is
a class
d&tsrmined
of
by
a
aJbstTax:tion certain
laord
t oken. We
adopt,
a
convention
which
Is
analogical
to
Convention
lib. C o n v e n t i o n
IV.2b.
The l e t t e r
X, w i t h o r w i t h o u t
subscript,
r a n g e s o v e r t h e family 2 The
expression
Induced
by
Definition
I.la
Is
the
definition
o f t h e e x p r e s s i o n XCX>: DEFINITION
IV.5
XCX> **^-^'^_ClBy
applying
Conclusion
we c a n d e m o n s t r a t e THEOKEM
*^^'^ € X ^ CCp,q,r) ^ F e X>. IV.4,
Definitions
I.la,
I.t
and
IV.S
that
IV.4
i? - n < X I xcxy >. This
theorem
somewhat difficult It then are
follows there then
is
is
induced
by D e f i n i t i o n
I.l
of
the
set
W. The
p r o o f o f t h i s t h e o r e m I s g i v e n i n t h e Annex.
from
Conclusions
a n r eWW
word t o k e n s
p
such and tj
IV.4 that
and
IV.3
that
r " fr T. By Axiom
such
that
If 1.12
rePsK, there
cCp ,q ,r >. Hence,
In
DUAL THEORIES
view
145
of
Conclusions
C^C fp 1 , [qf 1 , r ) , have t h u s
so
IV.2
that
and
we
can
that
[.**ll
^
^
^'^'^
^
C
We
a. pair
of
TLTk
also
IV.5
? e W\V ••
xaord
state
[p/]'
proved
THEOREM
Ev»ry
IV.4,
compound
word
typ&
_ ^ is
C
the
concatsTUition
of
types.
T h e o r e m IV.S I s induced by Axiom 1.12. The f o l l o w i n g
t h e o r e m i n d u c e d by t h e
last
axiom o f
holds: THEOREM
IV.6
r e IK ^ CCp,«j,r> ^ p,q « K. / / a word those To view
labels
are
prove
this
of
Since
type
is word
by
and
aissumption
IV.2,
that
1.13,
that
are
p
cCp ,<j ,r >. p ,q e y .
two
label
we
note
there
is
an
r eV
IV.2a,
it
follows
Convention
there
of
types,
then
types.
IV.4
IV.l t h a t the
concatenation
theorem
Conclusion
p,tfsLb
the
In
amd Q
that
such t h a t
ret** by
that
c"Cp,5>?^>
Since
r elf'
we
accordance
with
such
In
^"F^JI-
Conclusion
and q«« [ q . ] . T h i s
yield,
find,
that
from
^ [p.]
stating
assumption.
in
Conclusion
by
Conclusion
view
of
IV.4
we
Axiom have
p,5eS'. The c o n c e p t is
induced
by
of the
the
set
concept
"V of of
word t o k e n s . I t i s d e f i n e d t h u s :
the
all set
n-co»ponential of
all
word
types
n-component ial
146
CHAPTER IV DEFIKITION
IV.6
which y i e l d s CONCLUSION
IV.5
p ^""V ^
P - [p].
\ pe V
The
following
expressions
D e f i n i t i o n I.2a,b o f t h e s e t THEOREM
^V m V,
b.
F e ""^^F «•
IV.3,
easy
IV.l
Induced
by
the
inductive
"v;
IV.7
a.
The
are
proof
and
IV.2
V
of
V
Theorem
and
on
cCp,g,F>. IV.7,
based
Definitions
on
Conclusions
I.2a,b,
is
left
to
p will n o t
be
symbolized
IV.S, the
Reader. The l e n g t h \p\,
as
concept by
I p I.
of
could
a given
be
induced
by
Definition
word
excepted a of
given
in
type view
concept,
that
concept
of
the
definition
formulated is
in
induced
by
of
the
Sec.IV.l,
but
by
Definition
1.3: DEFINITION
IV.7
p e
W •* i.\p\
m n ^
p G
V:>.
The g e n e r a l i z e d d e f i n i t i o n o f t h e r e l a t i o n o f concatenation —h c o f fc+1 a r g u m e n t s Ck>2>, which h o l d s b e t w e e n l a b e l t y p e s , i s defined thus:
DUAL THEORIES
147
DEFINITION
The
following
Definition holding
IV.8
two
I.4a,b
between
THEOREM
of
-theorems the
label
are
Induced
generalized
relation
b.
n > 1 =*
Theorem
IV.8a
<^Pi'P2'' ' ^ n + l ' ^ " * **
Convention
Note
follows
Theorem
Axiom
IV.Sb
IV.2a,
directly follows
Conclusion
also
that
Definition
Definitions
Definitions
Definition
IV.8,
IV.8
IV.2,
IV.8 a n d C o n c l u s i o n
[p^]
^P2
_jl[ _
_
-
[P2]
-
_
1.4a
and
I.4b,
Theorem
1.1
conclusion have
1.11
yield
can
replace
demonstrated induced
Csee
Theorems
IV.6).
Moreover,
by
an
^ Pk"
^ P '
[P]
^
<:Pj,P2>-.Pj|j.P»
Definition
IV.8.
that
in
the
axiom
of
TLTk
IV.2*a,IV.l,
[^ft]
j^
=*
expression
from
from
IV.l,
cc5.P„+j.P>»
IV.6
ft > 1 ^ p^ -
We
'^
I.la.
CONCLUSION
This
concatenation
tokens:
** % <^"
and
of
Inductive
—n+1 — — — _ — CO Cp^,P2>P> ** <^
n « 1 ^
IV.2.
the
IV.8
a.
and
by
IV.2,
dual is
IV.2*b,
theory a
TLTp
theorem
IV.3,
in
IV.2*c,
every TLTp IV.5,
148
CHAPTER IV
analogon
In
expression Definition
the
form
being
a
IV.5,
of
an
expression
definition
Theorems
or
IV.4
a
and
induced
by
theorem
in
IV.ra.b,
it.,
such
TLTp
Definition
an Csee
IV.7
and
T h e o r e m IV.8J. T h u s w© o b t a i n THEOREM de/init
is
IV.2 .
ion
in
fTvery
TLTk i s a thesis
This t h e o r e m
implies
THEOREM I V . 3 .
Every
a thesis
Sec.
expression
in
induced
in
by
an
axiom
or
a
TLTp.
expression
induced
by
a
thesis
in
TLTk
TLTp.
IV.3.
Interpretation
i n TLTp o f T a r s k i ' s
axioms
of m e t a s c i e n c e
A.Tarski suffices
to
found
expressions primitive "sign
of
of
for
the
of
in,
of
consisting
system
of
expressions
Cand
concrete
following
the
"sign
of
logical
inclusion", of
two used,
sum", of
axioms
x,y,z,t
sequences
of
which
of
are
^UfW
the those
of
which
signs
and
are
the
those
axioms: "universal
fc-th
expressions
abbreviations the
of
classes of
respectively,
variables
labels
of
"variable
successive
axioms
names
algebra notation
o n e . In r e c o r d i n g the
specific
the
Tarski
that
The
of
in
v , a n d x'-y, a s
last
of
language
"sign
assumed
classes
a
occurring
"expression". qu,
also
the
negation",
"expression
sm,
gave
metascience.
terms
quantifier",
and
C1933]
shape", x
and
symbols:
y", ng,
terms
except
metascience
Tarski
range
expressions) equiform
over
the
set
treated
as
with
a
given
DUAL THEORIES
label,
149
and
that
the
vax-iable
X ranges
over
the
class
of
such
expressions;
no
two
expressions. We q u o t e h e r e T a r s k i ' s a x i o m s o f AXIOM
1.
ng,
sm,
(fu
amd
in
expressions out of t h e s e four are AXIOM 2.
v
is
differs
if
x^y
is
an
from
A is
a
natural
ng,
sm,
and
y
i f At x 1.
expression
e x p r e s s i o n s ; x'^y d i f f e r s
and only i f
from t h e expressions
and i n and f r o m e v e r y e x p r e s s i o n v AXIOM 3.
aire
identical.
an e x p r e s s i o n
number o t h e r t h a n 0; v
metascience:
the
if
and
only
expressions
if
ng,
x sm,
are
QU and
in
x^yas'^t
if
and f r o m e v e r y e x p r e s s i o n w. . AXIOM and
4.
only
CcO x"« and
If if
x,y,2
one
and y " t ;
t"u^y;
and
of
(
the
?> t h e r e
are
expressions,
following is
conditions
an e x p r e s s i o n
Cj') t h e r e
Is
an
S Cprinciple
of
mathematical
then
expression
u
is
u such
such
satisfied: that
that
x"«'-u
z"x^u
and
yM-U*^ t.
AXIOM satisfies in^X-f
the
?> If
following Ac i s
a
conditions:
natural
induction). Ca>
number
ngeX,
other
If
a
smeX,
than
O,
class
<}ueX then
X and
v.eX; AE
Cj') i f
xeX and y^X, t h e n x ' ^ e X , t h e n e v e r y
expression
is
in
the
c l a s s X. Tarski's G.Bryll
and
latter
by
that the
axioms
of
S.Miklos the
thesis
terms
metascience
119771) ng,
sm,
by
can
enriching
in,
-u
be
found
the CfceW)
in
language and
by
TLTp
Ccf.
of
the
assuming
150
CHAPTER IV
o
which
states
infinite this
t-hat,
the
enumerable
thesis
if
we
vocabulary
set,
is
postulate
valid in
of
simple
in
TUTp.
TLTk
that
word We
types
can
there
is
an
arrive
at
are
infinitely
e n u m e r a b l y many d i v e r s i f o r m s i m p l e word t o k e n s . In
such
Tarski's
a
we
axiom
ing,sm,(fVi,in,v x,y,z,t
case
,u,
variable
obtain
system
,v ,...y^y
and
respectively X
expression
by
the
r"p tj,
i.e.,
by
interpretation
given
above
by
by
variable
an
X,
the
expression
vai^iables
p,q,r,t
expression c
of
setting
the
variables
the
TLTp
by
replacing
the
in
,u,
z«x^y Csee
the
by
the
formula
>, and t h e t e r m " e x p r e s s i o n " by t h e t e r m "word t y p e " . Since,
by
expressions
Theorem
Induced
by
IV.3 ,
Conclusion
I.4a a r e v a l i d i n TLTp, we a r r i v e CONCLUSION
IV.7
CONCLUSION
IV.8
c<.p,Q,r> CONCLUSION
can
I.3a
and
which
Theorems
1.6
are and
at
IV.9
eeusily
find
that
_ ^ CCp,q,F). p,<j«el? for
the
T a r s k i ' s Axioms 1-3 b e c o m e t h e s e s i n TLTp. The
theorems
=»
F € !?v7 •• We
those
expression
above
interpretation
DUAL THEORIES
151
CCp,qi,s> yN c C r , t , v > V
Is
also
a
i * C s " v * » p « r A < j "
t
V
theorem
in
TLTp,
Induced
by
v cC«,t,q)>>
Theorem
1,2.
From
this
e x p r e s s i o n , by C o n c l u s i o n IV.8, we aarrlve at. CONCLUSION IV.IO
p,tf,T,t
e h' -^ CCp,qfS)
N/
The <*>, i s
^
/N CCr,t,v'>
^ C s « i i * » p " r y s q »
CcCr,u,p> ^ c'Cu,5>'t'» V
above
conclusion,
an e x p r e s s i o n
after
into
V
the
t v
Cc
application
which T a r s k l ' s
of
Axiom 4
the
formvila
turns
for
the
i n t e r p r e t a t i o n given above. We h a v e above, fact
to
Tarski's because,
demonstrate
Axiom 5 b e c o m e s by
C o n c l u s i o n 1.3c, t h a t CONCLUSION
that,
Theorem
a
IV.3 ,
for
the
theorem the
interpretation in
TLTp. I t
conclusion
is
given so
induced
In by
is
IV.11
K S X .-N _ A ^
S e c . IV.4.
The the
T h e t h e o r y TETp o f e x p r e s s i o n t y p e s
theory
theory
TETp
TETk o f
of
expression
TLTk o f l a b e l t o k e n s . We n o t e
expression
accordingly
types
tokens,
is
and
superstructured hence
on t h e
on
theory
1S2
CHAPTER rv
THEOREM and
in
Every
IV.4 .
part
icular
of
thesis
(accepted
TLTk, is
sentence)
a thesis
in
of
TETk,
TETp.
Now TETp is obtained from TETk by the joining to the latter of
all concepts
of
TETk.
concepts
The
induced
by
concepts
primitive
induced
of TLTk, which
been defined in TLTp
the
is a
by
the
and
derived aand
derived
TETk, have
already
primitive
fragment
of
concepts
CSec.IV.2>. It can thus be seen that
TETp
is based on TLTp and the following theorem holds: THEOREM a thesis
Every
IV.5 .
in
task
those
(accepted
sentence)
of
TLTp
is
induced
by
TETp.
Theorems IV.4 Our
thesis
and IV.S
now
primitive
reduces and
concepts in TLTk
will hereafter be used tacitly. to
derived
and
to
defining
the
concepts
of
formulating
concepts TETk
the
which
are
basic theorems
not which
describe the properties of the concepts so introduced. The concept
of
the
set
I
of
all
basic
abstrac
t
indices
-
o induced
by
the
defined
thus:
DEFINITION
concept
of
the
set
/
of
all
basic
indices
-
is
IV.9
o
o' %
w h i c h c a n b e r e p l a c e d by CONCLUSION
IV.12
^ ^ ^o •* '^(^I o ^ ' A
basic
consisting
abstract of
all
indices
index
is
equiform
W
the
class
with
a certain
of
abstraction basic
index.
DUAL THEORIES
The
153
set
T of
all
abstract
indices
-
the
induced
by t.he
concept, o f t h e s e t / o f a l l i n d i c e s - i s d e f i n e d t h u s : DEriNlTlON IV.IO
^ - v^' which c a n b e r e p l a c e d by CONCLUSION
IV.13
An abstract all
indices
index eqtiiform
is
the
with
class
of
abstraction
a certain
consisting
of
index.
By making u s e o f DEFINITION
IV.11
K
S X ^
A
tp^q e X ^ cCp,q,F> ^ r e X),
which i s induced by D e f i n i t i o n II.la, we c a n p r o v e THEOREM I V . 9
7 - n < X I x:cx>'* >, induced
by
Definition
II.1
of
the
theory
TETk.
Its
proof,
a n a l o g i c a l t o t h e p r o o f o f T h e o r e m IV.4, i s o m i t t e d . The b a s i c p r o p e r t i e s
of the s e t s
7
and 7 a r e e s t a b l i s h e d by
t h e o r e m s induced by Axioms II.1 and II.3-II.5; THEOREM IV.IO
0 ?< 7
s o
Tb, '
THEOREM IV.ll
CCp,9,r> -» r ^ 7 ; o
154
CHAPTER IV THEOREM
IV.12
r e 7sT THEOREM
•*
V
cCp,q,F>j
IV.13
r e / ^ C
II.l
Deflnit-ion
and
IV.12
and
follows
lmmecUat.eIy
Conclusion
IV.2,
Theorem II.4
IV.IO
Axioms
follows
II.3
from
Definition
IV.2.
IV.13,
Definition
Conclusion
IV.l.
7.
from
Theorem
and
Conclusion IV.ll
follows
from IV.12.
11.2
and
Conclusion
Conclusions
IV.13
and
Theorem
IV.13
IV.2,
follows
Axioms
1.7
IV.12,
IV.12,
Axiom
directly
from
and
II.5,
and
C o n c l u s i o n IV.13 a g a i n . We s e i f - e v i d e n t l y h a v e t h e '^
formula
o
o
which I s i n d u c e d by Axiom 11.2 o f TETk. The indices
concept CT\>1)
of -
the
set
induced
I by
of
the
all
n—component
concept
of
the
ictl set
defined thus: DEFINXTION
IV.12
"7 . "//^ This d e f i n i t i o n i s e q u i v a l e n t CONCLUSION
to
IV.14
p e '^r •»
V pel
p "
[p].
The f o l l o w i n g t h e o r e m s a r e induced by D e f i n i t i o n s II.2a,b:
abstract /
-
is
DUAL THEORIES
155
THEOREM
IV.14
a.
*r « 7 ,
b.
o F € "**7
«•
V pe T
V tf^T
c(p,i,F>. o
The
easy
and
proofs
IV.12,
of t>hese theorems, based
Definit-ions
II.2a,b,
Conclusions
on Conclusions IV.14 IV.2
and
IV.1,
and
Convention IV.2a, are omlt-t-ed. Note
now
Theorems
that
Remarks
IV.2*a,b,
IV.l
II.2
and
and
IV.2,
II.3,
Definition
Definition
IV.ll,
IV.Ca>,
Theorems
IV.8-IV.14, and formula <»••> yield THEOREM of
all
The
IV.6 .
axioms
and
expressions
de/ini
tions
induced adopted
by in
the
TLTk
dual
analoga
are
theses
by
the
in
TETp.'^*" Theorem IV.6 THEOREM analogon
of
implies
IV.7 .
Every
a thesis
in
expression
TLTk is
In view of Theorem IV.7 expression
induced
a thesis
in TETp.
we can see, for instance, that
I £/Si6, induced
by
dual
Conclusion
1.3 a
Cdual
the
analogon
of Conclusion I.3a>, is a theorem in TETp. Note further that the theorem induced by Axiom II.6 in TETk holds in TETp: THEOREM
IV.15
V n Jo • 0. The common
vocabulary with
the
of set
a of
simple all
basic
word
types
abstrac
t
has
no
indices.
elements
in
156
CHAPTER rv
Theorem
IV.15 follows
easily
from
Conclusions
IV.3 and IV.12
and Axioms 1.10 and 11,6. The relat.ion primit-lve
i
of lndicat.ing
concept
indicating
in TETk.
ttte indices
of
t,he indices
The concept, \eord types,
of word
of
t.okens
t-he r e l a t i o n
is a L of
induced by t h e former, i s
defined thus: DEFINITION 1V.13
'^^'5^ *• p€^ct> ' ^ " M -^ ^ - b^p^V Definition IV.13 and Axiom II.7 yield immediately CONCLUSION IV.15
p e Dcr> •• p ^ c o p - \p\' b.
5 € o'^co 4»
The
relation
y
i. has a s i t s domain
abstraction
of t h e r e l a t i o n
which
an index.
all
have
classes
of
?"['»]•
It
t h e s e t of all c l a s s e s
% determined
by t h o s e
word
has a s i t s counter-domain
abstraction
of
t h e relation
of
tokens
t h e s e t of
S: determined
by t h e
indices of word tokens. It II.2b IV.15a, from
follows that II.la
(.
from is
a
the
definition
function.
and IV.4 t h a t
Conclusions
IV.lSb,
Since
its
of it
domain Il.lb
L and from follows is
a
and
counter-domain i s a s u b s e t of I, we obtain THEOREM IV.16
I S W-X.I A 1. i s a function.
from subset
IV.13,
Conclusion Conclusions of that
W,
and its
DUAL THEORIES
157
T h i s t h e o r e m i s i n d u c e d b y Axiom II.7 o f TETk. On d e n o t i n g by i.C/>> t h e v a l u e o f domain
we
obtain,
a n d II.2b, t h e
by
Definition
L for
the argument
IV.13
and
p of
Conclusions
Its
IV.15a
following
THEOREM IV.16a
p "
[ p ] •^ P ^ DCty •* TCp) -
It is self-evident THEOREM TETk is
expression
p
of
forming
compound
expression
of
relation
are
and t h e elements
types.
In
p
the holds
word
p,
recording expression between
or:
p
is
a
definition
sequence
t h e binary
sequences
of
the
rP^> ^° of
II. 8
expression
, in t h a t
order.
tokens
of
of
of
the
p
of
domain
definite
word
a r e definite
word
read:
p
we
the
type
has
relation
relation
^^
words
compound
shall
relation
>
and
the
of
the
consisting
IV.14
n > 1 =» < p
- Pi - [',] from
^
t^,t^,."',t 0 1'
^D<.y
follows
this
definition
a
one-to-one
function.
IV.14,
Conclusion
IV.lSa,
Further
Axiom
II.9,
^h
-
['Q] -
' n
- P„ - C'n] - P - [F^'o'^i'
It is
Axiom
expression
i t s counter-domain
P^Pr.'P.t>--'P
the
w o r d t y p e s Pf.,p^,—,p DEFINITION
by
The e l e m e n t s
ordered
of
the
of
types.
finite
types,
use
compound
in t h e induced c o n c e p t
forming that
induced
in TETp.
operation
analogon
that The
a. ttteorem
The its
I V . 8 a.
[tCp>].
and it
''n^P
Conclusion follows
Conclusion
from IV.3
*
II.3
that
p
Definition and
Axiom
158
CHAPTER rv 00
1.10 t h a t a
that,
subset
of
function
has
DCL)W
as
the its
— k. U DCi.> as At-2
set
counter-domain.
its
This
domain
and
yields
the
f o l l o w i n g t h e o r e m , i n d u c e d b y Axiom II.9 o f TETk: THEOREM
IV.17
-
On
denoting
areuinent
by
-
*"
p:
>
of
its
-
—-.» D\V. * *
P^Pf.,P^,--,P
^Pf.,p^,--,P
-
fc
U DCO At-2
>
the
value
domain
we
of
p
obtain,
for
by
the
Definition
IV.14 a n d C o n c l u s i o n s IV.IS a n d I I . 3 , THEOREM IV.t7a
n > 1 ^ ' o - ' l - ' ' n « Ot^> - Po - Pn A word of
compound
relation
tokens' („,*.,,. ..,t 0 1 n %, represented words
t^.t^,...,t 0 1
=» P ^ P o ' ^ 1 ' • ' ^ n ^ "
expression
Pf.rP^>-tP
types
the
[*J
C'o] '^ ^1 -
type
-
consisting,
> determined
*, represented,
^<^'o'S'
by
classes
respectively,
, in n
that
expression order, that
token
^
'*n^] successively, of by
- is a class of abstraction
by compound
C'l] '^
abstraction indexed
of the
consisting
is of
of
the
word
relation of the
functor
t. 0
and its successive arguments t ,. ..,t 1 yx S e l f - e v i d e n t l y we h a v e THEOREM
IV.8 b .
TETk i s a theorem We
pass
concepts expression
of
now the types
r/ie
expression
induced
by
Axiom
II. 10
of
by
the
in TETp. to sets
definitions
of
E , E
E. T h e set
is defined
and thus;
concepts
induced E
of
all
simple
DUAL THEORIES DEFINITION
159 IV.15 ^s
•
^ s /' -% ^
This definit-ion c a n b e r e p l a c e d by CONCLUSION
IV.16
"^ For t-he s e t
E
of
all
s
compoMnd
expression
types
we h a v e
DEFINITION I V . 1 6
c
c'a
which c a n be r e p l a c e d by CONCLUSION
IV.17
^ ^ ^c •• p ^ "^
For t h e set DEFINITION
E of
all
expression
c
? types
W we h a v e
naturally
IV.17
f - E/^ , which cau^ be r e p l a c e d by CONCLUSION I V . 1 8
Conclusion
IV.16,
Definition
11.3a,
Conclusions
IV.3
and
IV.lSa, and Axiom 1.10 y i e l d THEOREM IV.lSa
E
m y n DCO.
s Conclusion
IV.17,
Definition
II.3b,
Axiom
IV.17a, C o n c l u s i o n IV.lSa and T h e o r e m IV.17 y i e l d
II.9,
Theorem
160
CHAPTCRIV THEOREM
IV.18b c
Finally,
by
Conclusion
IV.18,
Definition
II.3c
and
respectively,
by
C o n c l u s i o n s IV.16 and IV.17, we h a v e THEOREM IV.lSc E m E
Theorems Definitions We We
IV.18a,b,c
U E . c
induced,
II.3a,b,c.
now
shall
are
s
adopt
conventions
henceforth
II.3a-c, t h e
have
analogical to
to
observe,
Conventions
next
to
II.3a-G.
Conventions
following
C o n v e n t i o n
IV.3a.
p,(f,r,s,
The v a r i a b l e s
with or without
subscripts,
r a n g e o v e r t h e s e t E. b.
The v a r i a b l e s a.,h,c,d,^ ,a, w i t h o r w i t h o u t
range over the s e t c. .
The the
/.
LCp> m a
^
iCq'i
^ tCp.i
•
a.
,/^r^^
syntactic
category
formula DEFINITION
IV.18
subscripts,
•
6
^
tCr)
•
y. ( . C Q . >
«« 6 .
^
Ct=- with,
c
^
i.Cs> •
i-Cr.) «
the
index
d.
c.
^
f
LCS.>
is
>•
defined
d..
by
DUAL THEORIES
161
An expression abstract the
type
irxdex
relation
tohen
such
xehich
is
relation
that
is
and
% which it
in
has
is
% iithich the and
the
only
in
if
as
of
determines
syntactic
p is
its
the
a representative
From II.3a-c
Jf if
p
category
a class
of
tic
that
class
the
index
an
category of
the
abstraction
representative
syntac
vith
of expression
with
the
abstraction
index of
the
^.
above
definition.
Definition
IV.3a-c,
Conclusion
II.5b,
II.8,
Conventions
Theorem
IV.16a,
and
set
all
C o n c l u s i o n s IV.18 and IV.13 v/e o b t a i n THEOREM
IV.19
CT- The
syntactic
expression
category
types
whose
< p I 5 - f >. with
index
is
the
index
eQual
to
? the
is
the
index
of
f.
N o t e t h a t T h e o r e m IV.19 i s i n d u c e d by D e f i n i t i o n II.8. The
concept
Induced
by
the
family
c a t e g o r i e s of expression tokens i s t h a t syntactic
categories
DEFINITION
of
expression
of
types,
Ct
of
all
syntactic
t h e family defined a s
Ct
of
all
follows.
IV.19
CT - < C T - I f e T<E> >. K The
relation
•
of
syntactic
categorial
agreement
of
c
expression
tokens
has
its
analogon
in
the
relation
=
of
c
syntactic
categorial
agreement
of
expression
types
t h e f o l l o w i n g d e f i n i t i o n Induced by D e f i n i t i o n 11.10;
described
by
162
CHAPTER IV DEFINITION
IV.20
p = q «• V p , 5 e CT-.
r types
Two expression category
if
abstrac
t
they
?
p and q belong
belong
to
to a syntactic
the same
category
syntac
tic
the
same
with
index.
When formulating the theory TETk w e have adopted three other concepts: that of the set C
of
all constituents
of the
n-th
P
order- of an expression
token
constituents of an expression token p, <J^J2' C which
Jn^
of those
occupy
in
constituents
it
the
of the set C
p, that
and that
of the set
of aun expression
syntactic
of atU
positions
token
<7.,J,.,--,J > 1 2
Cn>0).
The c o n c e p t s
respectively,
of
those
by
induced
C—, C— and P P
concepts
DEFINITION t
by t h e s e
are
IV.21a e C- *^ ^"^ p t ,p
concepts
will
C— P
p
be
The
n
denoted,
definitions
a s follows.
Ct
"
[tl L J
^ p ^
-
[p'] L^J
^
t
G C ). p
ft"! ^ p \. i f
fpl \ri
^
t
e
C >. p
G
C
D E F I N I T I O N IV.21 7
DEFINITION
€
C- •• V p t,p
cT •
IV.22
*» ,rp ^' - [0 - p = w -
'^ ^ ' p
^
t
>.
P It
can be
II.12a-c,
proved,
Conclusions
by r e f e r e n c e IV.18
and
to IV.1,
Definitions Theorem
IV.21a a n d IV.17a
and
DUAL THEORIES
163
Conclusions
IV.lSa
and
II.16a,
that.
t.he
expression
induced
by
D e f i n l t - i o n s I H 2 a - c a r e t h e o r e m s i n TETp. H e n c e we h a v e THEOREM
IV.20
a.
_ _0 t e C— ^
p B
b.
^ ^ ^ " • * * _ _
t, ^ _
_ < p « p < 7 , 7 ,...,7 ) /v
- 0<)
A > 0 =»
«*
V
'^ The
following
"^ = ' ' / '
f e C - ).
reC—
expression
induced
by
Definition
II.12d
f o l l o w s i m m e d i a t e l y f r o m D e f i n i t i o n s IV.21, II.12d a n d IV.21a: THEOREM
IV.20d
7 e C - «* V T g c p n p By
making
use,
in
particular,
of
Definitions
IV.22
and
II.13a,b a n d T h e o r e m IV.17a we c a n p r o v e THEOREM IV.21
_ _0-,> _ _ « e C— ** p G £ and p c of p,
a. expansion
t
is
the
j^-th -'i
xaord
of ^
the
taord
of
the
-^A'-'2'•'-'fc+1^ b.
t
expansion The
€ C—
of last
^
an element
of
theorem
gives
the
t
is
set
C
the
expressions
J.
.-th for
Induced
k>0. by
Definition
II,13a,b. It TETk
is self-evident has
its
that
analogon
in
every an
axiom Induced
and e v e r y expression
definition which
is
of a
164
CHAPTER IV
t ^ h e s i s i n TETp. T h e f a c t II.l-II.lO the
of
basis
IV.15,
TETk of
IV.20,
and
IV.14a,b,
Il.la,
in
IV.17,
Theorems
Definitions
expressions TETp
IV.10-IV.13,
IV.8*a,
IV.9,
the
theorems
Theorems
IV.16,
Theorems
are
that,
II.l,
and
definition
IV.8 . of
Every
TETk is
T h e o r e m IV.8
It
in
follows a
the
Ct
is
family a
Every
logical
IV.ll, and
induced
II.8,
by
11.9,
11.10,
axiom
or
substantiates by
an
a
TETp.
expression
induced
by
a
thesis
of
TETk
TETp. from
particular,
Theorems
implies
THEOREM I V . 9 . i s a thesis
on
IV.19
are
induced
in
and
Definitions
II.3a-c,
expression a thesis
Axioms
Definition
IV.21a,b
II.2a,b,
by
established
C***>,
IV.19,
II.12a-d, a n d 11.13a,b, r e s p e c t i v e l y . T h i s THEOREM
be
IV.8*b.
IV.18a-c,
IV.20a-d
can
formula
and
induced
Theorem
theorem of
1V.9
induced
all
syntactic
classification
of
that
by
if
£i«!0 t h e n
Theorem
II.6.
categ^ories the
set
of
£,
we
It
have,
states
that
expression
determined
in
types by
the
e q u i v a l e n c e r e l a t i o n =. C
Sec.
IV.5.
T h e d u a l t l i e o r y DTSCL
The t h e o r y tokens
Is
latter
of
including expression
'
TSCL o f
obtadned one the
simple c a t e g o r i a l
from
the
theory
axiom
CAxiom
definition
of
tokens
of
a
given
TETk
11.11) the simple
languages by
and
set
S
the
of
expression
joining
to
the
several
definitions,
of
well-formed
categorial
aJ.1
language
£.
The
DUAL THEORIES
dual
-theory
language obtained all
165
DTSCL,
It
described
from
concepts
TSCL.
by
by
concepts
of
makes the
TSCL by j o i n i n g Induced
The
concepts
which
TETk
the
possible
system to
the
primitive
induced
have
It,
adready
by
CJf > latter and
the
been
t.o Csee the
on TSCL b u t o n TETp a s well. We a c c o r d i n g l y
and
IV.IO .
Evory
in partic-ular
thesis
of TETk,
in
definitions
of
concepts
of
and
derived
TETp. I t
follows
superstructured
have
(accepted
i s a thesis
is
primitive
defined
t.he
Sec.IV.l),
derived
t h e r e f o r e f r o m t h e a b o v e t h a t DTSCL i s n o t only
THEOREM
analyse
sentence)
of
TSCL.
in DTSCL.
and THEOREM IV.11 . a thesis
Every
thesis
Caccepted
sentence)
of
TETp
is
in DTSCL.
Ve shall h e n c e f o r t h
make t a c i t
references
to
Theorems
IV.IO
and IV.ll*. The definition
theory of
DTSCL
the
set
includes,
S of
all
above
^aell—formed
all,
the
expression
following types
of
t h e l a n g u a g e X: DEFINITION
IV.23
5 - S/^ , which c a n b e r e p l a c e d by CONCLUSION
IV.19
^ ^ ^ *• p ^ ^ A well-formed of
abstraction
expression consisting
type of
all
of
W the
language
expressions
Jf i s
equiform
a
class
with
a
166
CHAPTER IV
c e r t a i n w e l l - f o r m e d e x p r e s s i o n t-oken o f The Cn>0>
see -
a
Introduced quotient
S of
conceptin
of
all
well-formed, Induced
TSCL
-
the set
expression
by
is
£.
t-he
defined
types
concept-
as
a
S by t h e r e l a t i o n
of
of
order
n
t-he
set-
S
quotient
family:
of equiformlty.
the
H e n c e we
have D E F I N I T I O N IV.23a
T h i s d e f i n i t i o n c a n b e r e p l a c e d by t h e f o l l o w i n g C O N C L U S I O N IV.20
pe S By m a k i n g u s e o f t h e d e f i n i t i o n s of
all
to
inductive induced
demonstrate Definition
by t h e
that
II.4a,b
Definition
the
adopted above expressions
of
the
set
S
IV.4c
of
the
set
induced
and S
we h a v e
the are
first
by
the
expression theorems
in
DTSCL. THEOREM
rv.22
a.
S m E s
b.
p .
*^^S -
P - *S .
^V^ _ _ ^ _ P^,P^,...P^
^ S
Ca,aj,...,a^,aQ»,
oo
c.
S .
Theorem and
IV.16
IV.22a and
U "S.
follows
Definition
immediately II,4a.
The
from somewhat
Conclusions more
IV.20
difficult
DUAL THEORIES
proof
of
167
Theorem
follows
easily
IV.22b
from
is
given
in
Conclusion
t-he
Annex.
IV.19,
Theorem
Definition
IV.22c
II.4c
and
C o n c l u s i o n IV.20. In of
the
the
theory
TSCL we
condition
states
that
condition.
(5CX)
the
In
set
we
have
is
the
least
S
expression
in t h e
T h e o r e m II.2 i s valid. N o t e REMARK
IV.l.
Definition
II.5
In of
the
adopted
and
DTSCL t h e
c a n be s h o w n t h a t
have
latter
an
auxiliary
proved
Theorem
set
6<:X)
theory
which is
definition II.2
which
satisfies
that
induced
by
6CX).
It
a theorem analogical
to
that
DTSCL
an
condition
expression <5CX> i s
induced
the
by
the
of
the
definition
c o n d i t i o n <5tX>. The
following
theorem
induced
by
Axiom
11.11
is
also
a
t h e o r e m in DTSCL. THEOREM IV.23
o Theorem II.4a,
IV.23
follows
Conclusions
IV.19,
easily
from
Axiom
IV.20,
II.4a,
IV.12
11.11, and
Definition II.6b
and
T h e o r e m IV.lfia. The s e t of
all
of
the
functors defined
B of
functor set of thus:
all
basic
types B of £,
all
expression
types
of £ are concepts expressions
respectively.
These
of
of
J? and t h e
induced by t h e
J? and concepts
the
set
set
F
concepts F
of
self-evidently
all are
168
CHAPTER IV DEFINITION
IV.24
DEFINITION
IV.25
and
F- f4 . We u s e t h e r e s u l t . i n g CONCLUSION
IV.21
CONCLUSION
IV.22
conclusions
and
t-o
formulate
theorems
which
are,
respectively,
induced
by
D e f i n i t i o n s II.6 and II.7, a d o p t e d i n TSCL: THEOREM IV.24
a " < p < = S | a e 7
>
o
and THEOREM IV.25
F » < : p e S
I a e 7 N 7 >. o
By the
Theorem
set
index types
of
IV.24
those
i s a basic is
the
the
set
of
well-formed index.
set
of
all
expression
By T h e o r e m all
basic
those
expression types
whose
IV.25 t h e s e t well-formed
types
of
is
abstract
all
expression
functor types
w h o s e a b s t r a c t index i s n o t b a s i c . Theorem
IV.24
follows
from
Conclusion
IV.21,
Definition
DUAL THEORIES
169
II.6,
Conclusion
II.2,
Conventions
II.3c
IV.25
foUows
from
Conclusion 1.5 ,
IV.19,
IV.19,
Axiom
Theorem and
IV.3c
amd
IV.16a,
Conventions
Conclusion
IV.22,
IV.12.
and
Axiom Theorem
Definition
Conclusion
II.3c
II.6a,
Conclusion
Conclusion
Theorem
II.2,
IV.16a,
II.7,
II.6a,
IV.3c,
and
Theorem Conclusions
IV.13 a n d IV.12. The of
concepts
of
well-formed
basic
CtCS), those
of
CtCB),
CtCS>,
£
are
and
II.lla,b,c,
In
and
of
the
induced,
of X,
CtCf>
writing
the
are
syntactic
the
family
C t CF>
respectively,
Without
DTSCL
all
family
we merely n o t e
by
out
categories
CT
of
all
the
the
of
all
functor
concepts
of
definitions
of
that
definitions
expressions
of
induced
the by
concepts Definitions
respectively.
now
Join
to
the
four-argument
relations:
cortsti
n-th
the
CTCS)
types and
CtCf).
IV.2.
CKBy
We
X
of
induced c o n c e p t s
REMARK
family
expression
categories
categories
the
tuent
of
relation
Cy)
DEFINITION
IV.26a
DEFINITION
IV.26
FCp/cjfJs **•
V
of
order
theory the
DTSCL
r&lation
Cfor n>0> of
replacing
a consti
two
>
definitions of
replacing
an expression t-uent
of
of
an
type,
a
and
expression
type.
( ^ ^p'J ^ q » |"^j ^ r » ^J^2 ^ J » ^s"j ^
r(.pyq'}s:>.
170
CHAPTER IV
By r e f e r r i n g t-o t,he d e f i n l t - i o n s a d o p t e d a b o v e we c a n p r o v e THEOREM
IV.26
a.
rCpyefy
s ** s,i-
b.
r<J>?^y^s 4» s,r
e S ^ t f ^ s ^ p m r , e S ^
V
V
<s m pCSjj,s^,...,s^> >N r • pcFp,r^,...,r^> y^
- 0 < y < n f ? - ^^ - P - r^ -
fc^j
^j, -
?fc»-
0<*
c.
* > 0 ^ Cr
d.
rCpytf^s
Theorems
«• » rCp/qi) s .
IV.26a-d
are
expressions
induced,
respectively,
by
D e f i n i t i o n s II.14a-c and II.14d. Theorem
IV.26a
follows
Immediately
from
Definitions
IV.26a,
II.14a and C o n c l u s i o n s IV.19 and IV.I8. Theorem
IV.26d
follows
immediately
from
Definitions
IV.26,
II.14d and IV.26. The p r o o f s o f T h e o r e m s IV.26b,c a r e g i v e n i n t h e Annex. Prom t h e a n a l y s e s c a r r i e d o u t aibove we o b t a i n THEOREM definition
IV.12 . of
£very
expression
TSCL i s a thesis
induced
by
an
axiom
and
IV.ll
IV.12 and
a
in DTSCL.
0
Theorem
or
41
can be proved
IV.22a-c, Remark
IV.2 and Theorems IV.26a-d.
by reference IV.l, Theorems
to Theorems IV.8 IV.23-25,
Remark
DUAL THEORIES
l''!
Theorem IV.12 THEOREM
yields
IV.13 .
TSCL IS a thesis By availing
Every
expression
indxtced
ourselves
categories
of
Theorem
of
IV.13
well-formed
logical
partition
of
types
of
syntactically
the
partition
a.
thesis
of
in DTSCL. we can s t a t e
DTSCL we have a theorem which says that syntactic
by
being
the
set
determined
S
the
all
the
types
well-formed
categorial
by
family C t <S5 of
expression
of
that-
=
all a
expression
language
relation
is
in
X,
Ccf.
that
Theorem
c
II.6a>.
The
II.7a,b>,
analoga
that
syntac tic
is
of
the
both
fttsc
/-undaanental
categories
for
Csee
Sec.II.l
theorems
expression
types
and
of of
the
Theorems theory
X, are
also
of valid
in DTSCL.
Sec. IV.6.
The
The duail t h e o r y DTSC«»-L
dual
co-language
theory X
of
DTSCtar-L
expression
C<jy-X > given
in
Sec.IV.l.
by the
joining
to
the
induced
by
primitive
based
on
derived
its
TETk,
concepts
and of
the
and in particular
possible described
DTSC«*-L
of
the
latter
is
to
analyse
by
the
obtained of
concepts.
Since
induced have
by
already
the
all
the
system
from
definitions
derived
concepts
the
Every of
and
it
types,
Now
latter
TETp, i t i s self-evident THEOREM IV.14 .
makes
TSC«*-L
concepts
TSCcj^L
primitive
been
defined
is and in
that the following metatheorems hold: thesis
TETk,
is
(accepted a thesis
sentence)
in DTSC«*-L.
of
TSC«*-L,
172
CHAPTER rv
THEOREM IV.15 . a
thesis
in
€very
thesis
(accepted
sentencey
of
TETp
is
DTSCMP-L.
T h e s e t w o met-at-heor-ems will h e r e a f t - e r b e u s e d taclt-ly. It- c a n a l s o to
be s e e n
TETp t h e d e f i n i t i o n s
that
DTSCiar-L cam b e o b t a i n e d
o f all c o n c e p t s
induced
by j o i n i n g
by t h e
concepts
i n t r o d u c e d i n C h a p t e r III. The of
first
two definitions
the concepts
to
be
given
induced by t h e c o n c e p t s
of
here
are
definitions
the sets
O and Vr,
respectively. DEFINITION
IV.27
ODEFINITION
O/^
IV.28
The concepts thus defined are termed the set types
and the set
of
all
variable
types,
of
alt
operatoT
respectively.
Definition IV.27 is equivalent to C O N C L U S I O N IV.23
^ ^ ^ •* p ^ ^ D e f i n i t i o n IV.28 I s e q u i v a l e n t CONCLUSION
M
to
IV.24
p e P 7 *• ^ ^ ^ p - [ p ] . From
Conclusions
IV.16 we o b t a i n
IV.23
immediately
and
IV.24,
Axiom
III.l
and
Conclusion
DUAL THEORIES
173
THEOREM
IV.27
O U Vr ^ E . s The types
set
of
are
all
operator
subsets
of
the
types set
of
and all
the
set
simple
of
all
variable
expression
types.
Theorem IV.27 i s induced by Axiom III.l o f TSCta^L. It- i s s e l f - e v i d e n t
that
THEOREM
The
and
III.
IV.16a .
3 of
TSC«*-L are
The c o n c e p t its
of
element type
record
the
type,
a
type
set
of
of
induced
expression an
the
operator
is
from type.
metalinguistic
definition
which
of
the
has
III.
in
S
£
Is
defined
in
makes
to-language
as
an
type,
a
III,
we
possible
to
Chapter it
An
expression
operator
As
DTSCu-L type-
a compound
an
expression
expressions
Axioms
expression
as
an
operator
token
a>-language
successively,
and
by
in DTSCw^L.
pCOxVrxO, t h a t
consisting,
variable adopt
concept
expression of
theorems
an o p e r a t o r
anaiogon in t h e
operator
expressions
J? i n
a
simpler
form. DEFINITION
The p
is
IV.1
expression an
operator
on
operator p ,
the scope p Definition
the
the
left
side
expression indexlcal
of t h a t IV.l*,
of
type
variable
this
definition
consisting p
of
that
of
is
read:
the
main
operator,
and
operator. Conclusions
IV.23,
IV.24,
II.5b, T h e o r e m IV.17a and D e f i n i t i o n III.l* y i e l d
IV.18,
Ill.ta.b,
174
CHAPTER IV THEOREM
IV.28
p - •^<.p^,p^,p^:>
^ p ^ , p ^ y p ^ , p cp^ -
^ ^2 "
An operator p , its
expression
iTidexical
abstraction
of
expression
token
the
main
are,
tion
We being
the
adopt a free
type
consisting and
of
its
the
followlne
a
scope
%,
determined
the
following
is by
the
in an expression
a class an
p
types of
operator of
operator
expression
tokens:
and
of
expression
-
main
p
variable
definition
[pj
P^
of
representatives
determine
variable
its
indexical
respectively,
the
^ P ' I P ^ ^ P -
relation
p ,
that
[^2]
p
consisting
operator
p , which abstrac
variable
[Po] - Pi -
its
scope
the
classes
p^,p.
and
relation
of p .
of
induced
by
type:
DEFINITION IV.29
pCjvyq This
4^
definition
V
Cp - [p] ^ q - M
yields
the
^ p
following
theorem
D e f i n i t i o n III.l: THEOREM IV.29 p
** p
e
Vr
y. p
e
C— -^ ~i _
_
Y_
_
/N r
e
C— A p e
^ p
C—
Cr , r , r
A p «
> ^
r^>.
The proof of this theorem is given in the Annex. The S ,
B,
concepts F,
corresponding
induced
defined
in
quotients
by
the
concepts
TSCu-L,
are
of
those
sets
of now
by
sets: defined
the
S,
S,
S
as
relation
,
the %.
We
DUAL THEORIES
accordingly
'75
have
DEFINITION IV.30
and CONCLUSION
IV.25
pe S DEFINITION
IV.31
S -
S /
and CONCLUSION
IV.26
^ ^ ^ *• p^S ^ " DEFINITION
IV.32
and CONCLUSION
IV.27
pes DEFINITION
IV.33
and CONCLUSION
IV.28
pes DEFINITION
IV.34
W'
176
CHAPTER FV
and CONCLUSION
IV.29
P ^ ^ ** ^ DEFINITION
P -
\P\'
IV.35
and CONCLUSION IV.30
P ^^ ** P^FP ' By
referring
following
to
Conclusions
theorems
which
IV.2S
are
M and
Induced
IV.26
by
we
prove
Definitions
the
III.2a,b
and III.2c: THEOREM IV.30
a.
°S - £ , s
b.
p 6 ***S • • p e * S s/ V ^ '^ n>l — —
V — h.-^
Cp - pCpp,p^,...,p^> ,v p^ e O A c"" Ca,a^,...,a^,aQ)> v
dp m p <-PQ,P^,P^'>
^ P^ e
S ^ P^f'^^P^. •^
pQ'Pi'Pi'P^
CD
s -
U '*s. n«0
Theorem Definition simply
IV.30a III.2a
from
follows and
immediately
Conclusion
Conclusion
IV.26,
IV.16.
Definition
from
Conclusion
Theorem III.2c
IV.30c and
IV.25, follows
Conclusion
DUAL THEORIES
177
IV.25. The p r o o f o f T h e o r e m IV.30b i s g i v e n i n t-he Annex. By
availing
111.3
and
find
that
by
ourselves
following
the
of
the
following
Conclusion
proof
of
theorem,
IV.27
Theorem
induced
and
Definition
IV.30b
by
we
Definition
easily III.3,
i s valid: THEOREM
IV.31
P ^S""^
**X
n>i
PQ'P^'
^
k^^P 'Pjx^ 5
- P^pQ'Pi'
^ Pjj « O ^ c" Likewise,
by
applying
111.4 and by f o l l o w i n g
to
the
Conclusion
proof
of
'Pr?
^
Ca,a^,...,a^,aQ». IV.28
Theorem
aund
IV.30b
Definition
we
find
that
t h e f o l l o w i n g t h e o r e m , i n d u c e d by D e f i n i t i o n III.4 i s vzdid: THEOREM
IV.32
p e S " « » V _ _V_ _ P0'P\'P2'P3
< p - ^*^^0'^1'^2'' ^ ^2 ^
^ '^
•^ P^'-f'^^P^ ^ P3 " Pi -^ '^ *^"'*'l''*2'*'0'*'* From and
Conclusion
IV.12,
IV.29,
Theorem
Definition
IV.lfia,
III.S,
Conclusion
Conclusions III.6
and
IV.26 II.2b,
C o n v e n t i o n s II.3c and IV.3c and Axiom II.2 we o b t a i n THEOREM IV.33
B « < p e S | a e 7 From IV.13
and
Conclusion IV.12,
IV.30,
Theorem
Definition IV.16a,
o
>.
III.6,
Conclusions
II.3c and IV.3c and Axiom II.2 we o b t a i n
Conclusions III.6,
IV.26,
Conventions
178
CHAPTER rv THEOREM
IV.34
F « < p e S
I a e 7 \ 7 >. o
The
last,
t-wo t h e o r e m s
a r e induced
by D e f i n l t - i o n s
III .5 and
III.6, r e s p e c t - i v e l y . The
following
two
expressions,
induced
by
the
last
two
a x i o m s o f T S C M ^ L , r e s p e c t i v e l y , a r e t h e o r e m s i n DTSCw-L: THEOREM
IV.3S o
and THEOREM
IV.36
rcs"> n To ^ 0 . Theorem IV.12,
111.5a
follows
IV.35
follows
and
Il.Sa
immediately
from and
from
Axiom
III.4,
Theorem
Axiom
Conclusions
IV.16a.
III.S,
1V.27,
Theorem
Conclusions
IV.36
IV.28,
IV.12,
111.5b and II.5a and Theorem IV.16a. In TSC«*-L w e h a v e CftBJ,
adopted
Ct
definitions
o f t h e families
of t h e r e l a t i o n s
CtCS>,
f / i " and CV).
We
now a s s u m e t h a t REMARK IV.3. are
defined
In DTSCw-L t h e c o n c e p t s
by
expressions
induced
by
cTcS), c7(S>
and cTcFi
Definitions
III.7a,b,c,
respectively. The e x p r e s s i o n s r < p / g > s and TCp/cf>s DEFINITION
r^pyq^i^s
4«
ax-e d e f i n e d t h u s :
IV.36a
V^ ^ <^P^\t>\ y- «»-[<»] ^ '•"[''3 ^ * • [ * ]
^ r
>.
DUAL THEORIES
179
DEFINITION
1V.36
r
^
Cpm [p]
O y ul j T j S
Definlt-ions immedlat-ely 111.8a.
The
on
IV.28, and
Definitions
Theorems
Definition The
Definitions
state
that
In
is
by
IV.16 b.
view
Theorems
The
IV.36,
a n d Ill.Sd of
proof
are
been
definition
IV.16 . of
Every
TSCianL is
the
induced
in
IV.26b,
is and
and
IV.18
induced
Theorem
follows We
holds
IV.17a
IV.26
of
by
IV.26c.
immediately
can
by
I.la
Definition
Theorem
theorem
proof
IV.36a.
accordingly
De/ini
tions
in DTSC»*-L. said
IV.27,
expression a thesis
above
IV.16*a,
IV.3 and T h e o r e m IV.16 b we c a n s t a t e THEOREM
also
Ill.Sd
and
theorems
IV.IS*,
III.8b
Conclusions
Definition
hois
by
Theorems
the
Axiom
induced
111.8b,
of
on
and
of
IV.3a,
III.8d
IV.26
proof
Expressions
what
IV.8*,
the and
and
is
fc»j
Definition
to
modelled
induced
from
THEOREM
11.3a
which
by
IV.36a
III.3a,b.
m.8c
theorem
Ill.8a.-c
theorem
similai^
" ~
Conclusion
induced
proof,
Conventions
" "
111.8a,
the
theorem
DTSCiw-L. I t s based
IV.36a,
yield
^ qm [jj] ^ F" [ r ] ^ s » [ s ] ^ r
" "
and
referring
IV.29-IV.36,
to
Remark
that induced
by an
axiom
or
a
in DTSCw-L.
This leads u s t o THEOREM
IV,17 .
TSC«»-L i s a thesis
Every
expression
induced
by
a
thesis
of
we c a n
state
in DTSCw^L.
By a v a i l i n g o u r s e l v e s
of
t h e above
metatheorem
180
in
CHAPTER IV
part-lcular
theorem
stating
categories is
a
t.hat.
of
t-he
that
dual
the
well-formed
logicad
expression
in
of
that
family
expression
classification
types
theory
of
DTSC»»-L
C t CS> types
the
set
we
of
of S
all
the of
languaige, d e t e r m i n e d
have
t-he
syntactic
Ci>-language J?
all
well-formed
by t h e
relation
= c
of
categorlal
agreement
metatheorem
also
Induced
both
III.6a,b>, syntac
tic
by that
is
authorizes fttsc
us
hold in DTSC«»-L,. The
for
to
given
/xindamental
categories
Theorem
in
types £
that
Chap.III
theorems
expression
oj-language
state
III.5>.
Csee
of of
the
the the
The
said
theorems Theorems theory
of
oi—language
£
can, therefore, correctly
be
referred to as a syntactically categorlal language.
FINAL
We
have
languag^es
presented pertaining
respectively, variables theory In
i.e.,
working
out
to
trend
nominalism.
question
accord
that
both
to
the
fact
linguistic
on
the
theories
in
have
that
logical
a
u-languages,
operators
been
we
based
have
ontology
done
in
and
of
and
on
the
Le^niewski-Ajdukiewicz-Gurry.
We h a v e
objects
one
of
the
conceptions
contain
conceptions
t o say, recognizing the f a c t 1
languages
which
categories
of
axiomatic
simple
languages
syntactic
consideration
in
to
formal
bound by t h e m . B o t h
of
refers
two
REMARKS
so
dual
of
into
language
because,
and
taken
which
without
semiotic
ontological
caulling
practice
status,
that
hand,
inscriptions,
including have
words
a
s e n s o r y c o g n i t i o n , i n a word, a r e c o r i c r e t e on t h e o t h e r , linguistic e n t i t l e s , expressions, are classes of and a r e t h u s a b s t r a c t , formalizing
that of
toh»ns, language
entitles. ontological
both
theories
we
and h e n c e c o n c r e t e and
Typos,
taking
we
postulated
that
nature,
by r e f e r e n c e t o Thus,
ideal,
were
is
words
material
and
objects,
entities, started objects, their
abstract
assigned
to
entities,
including
equiform
and
definite
s h a p e , a r e e x t e n s i v e i n s p a c e and t i m e and a c c e s s i b l e
in
is
that
e x p r e s s i o n s , are physical o b j e c t s t h a t
2
we
from ax-e
the
the
basic
existence objects
derived
aissumption
of
existence
stratum
as
primitive
a
different
and
defined
tokens. into
consideration 181
the
nominal
is tic
trend,
182
FINAL REMARKS
which
is
otherwise
in
agreement,
LeSniewski
and
ontological
formalized
both
theories
tokens
and
that
accordingly tokens
of
Ctofcen
extension)
at
level
languages of expression
types.
demonstrated
languages theories
of of
important set
of
types,
level,
among
them.
because
property
sets
every
of
all
or
an
t ype
I eve J,
which
the
theories
also
based
on
light
of
corresponding
the
is
the
axioms
a
the
describes
of
natural.
The
level,
i.e.,
them,
that
concepts
latter. hence
at
token
which
dual
the
This
also
is
every tokens,
level,
when
describes
induced
is
relations
expression
the
dual
the
conceptCs>
theory,
hence
categorlally,
but
self-evident
that
as
a a
types. the
syntax and
of
type
and
the
language
theories
the
corresponding of
the
and
language of
theorem
of
tokens, of
expression
theories
among
object
at
dual
the
the
definition,
expression definitional
quite
relations
induced of
is
at
properties
We
corresponding
and
every
properties
the
of
level.
of
their
types
property or properties
into
theories
we
that
tofcen
from
concepts
tokens,
the
axiom,
language of e x p r e s s i o n In
to
a given theory of
translated
theory
types,
Inherit
which d e s c r i b e s
the
the
the
Cas
to
expression
that
object
i.e.,
theorem of
at
is
of
from
passing
Stanistaw
levels,
formulated
tokens
induced r e l a t i v e
token
so
languages
we
of
Kotarbiriski,
different
next
the
expression
point
concepts
that
views
Tadeusz
axiomatic
and
type
We
the
two
first
the
of
starting
level),
at
relsm
types,
constructed
with
of
above
it
languages
definitions
is of
which
expression are
types
expressions
both can
be
induced
FINAL REMARKS
183
by t-he axioms and definitions of the corresponding languages
of
expression
considerations
tokens.
pertaining
to
Hence
the
in
theories of
purely
syntactic
theoretical
and
categorial
description of language we cain disregard the ontological nature of its objects. In such a case the postulatlon at the outset of the
existence
necessary.
of
But
linguistic
from
concrete
the
point
objects
of
view
Ctokens>
of
is
philosophy
not the
adoption of such an assumption a«nd the basing of the theory of the syntax of language on it is of essential importance because It points to
the
existence
abstract
of
The
above
more
linguistic
philosophical
considerations much
possibility o/ avoiding
presented
si.rongly,
objects
in
thesis,
in
which
the
this is
postvilation syntactic
which
book,
shown
is
can by
of
the
analyses.
a
be
the
result
of
substantiated latest
studies
carried out by the present author.
it
We
shall brieffy
is
known,
the
substantiate logical
the
conception
opinion
voiced
of
ontology
the
above. As of
the
syntax of language should provide formal foundations that would enable one to formalize the theory of language at two levels by taking
into account
the
dual nature
of
linguistic
objects. The
theory of language can thus be constructed if we start from the assumption that the study of language is based on object types, that
is
ideal
representations
entities in
intuitively
tokens,
that
interpreted
is
concretes
entities derived from
the former. In such
refer
philosophical trend, namely
we
to
begin
a
different
the
formalization
of
the
as
theory
treated
a case
of
having
we
as
obviously
Platonism, and the
syntax
of
184
FINAL REMARKS
languag^e
object
typ«
at. t.he
t-ypes and
types. Later, by level C token
level
by
constructing making
level')
we
post.ulat.lns
first
use
of
the
Its
construct
t.he
theory
of
extension,
the
exlst.ence
theory
expression
at
of
of
the
the
second
syntax
language of expression tokens by defining the concepts at
of
that
level by reference to types. Then
the
problem
arises: would
the
descriptive
potential
of
such a theory of the syntax of language be an argument
to the
detriment
in
of
that
theory
of
the
syntax
formalization of which the noihinalistic Let the nature of that The
relation
of
langusige
the
approach was used?
problem
concatenation
of
be explained by an
between
types
is
example.
a
function,
whereas when defined on tokens it is not a function. Should not that
fact be of an essential importance
in the
description
of
the syntax of language based on the Platonixing
approach? Does
it
new,
not
allow
one
to
describe
some
essentiatlly
different, properties of objects at the
type
different properties of objects at the token
level,
and
even
and new
or
level"?
The answer to this essential question is in the negative if we
take
into
discussed carried 1990],
in out
and
account
this by
the
categorlal
book. This the
developed
is
present in
11988
approach
demonstrated
author, and
by
indicated
19891. The
to the in
example
formal theories of simple categorlal lau-iguages, which the outlined opposing nominal
is tic
and Platonisiing
language, studies
[1986
and
of
two
represent
approach to
the syntax of language, respectively, demonstrates that the set of theses
Caxioms, definitions, au^d theorems>
of
both
theories
FINAL REMARKS
is
the
185
same: t h e
shown
that
every
respectively has
its
the
type
of
Cor
level,
other
in
first
property
at
is
theories
allow
a
for
languages though
ontological linguistic The
two-level
in
an
the
theories
and
conclusion
of
reference
level, can by
property
theory
described be
a
framework
of
manner,
the
fofcen) has
at
the of
such
a
theory.
interpretable
and
of
simple
categorially,
start
matter
the
first
syntax
is
consideration
of
thesis
into
the
the
that
thesis
concepts by t h e
of
at
Ci> e i t h e r
transposed
thesis
a
respectively
unvtvally
in
to
both
of
from the
formulated
other
that
in
categorially
existence
described
of
the
even
opposing
nature
syntax
interpretability
stating
approached the
theories
mutual
thesis
c a n be
to-languages
of
their
languages
assumption
other
by
theory,
of
objects.
philosophical
simple
type
in a s e n s e ,
under
assumptions
concepts
t h e corresponding
or
analogical
equivalence
languages
are
of
Cor
typei
Cii>
property
described
is Cor
one
level,
the
token
of
the of
the
it
thesis
every
described
Thus t h o s e
by a
Moreover,
at
conversely,
by a t h e s i s
which
concepts
to/ten>
concepts
theory,
ecfui-ualent.
corresponding
And
Cor r e s p e c t i v e l y
the
of
of
analogue in a p r o p e r t y of
token
the
the
theory.
described
are
described
respectively
corresponding
its
theories
property
type)
analogue
the
level
said
of
ideal
also
with
categorially,
theories
of
thus
syntactic one
can
linguistic reference and
language,
t h e o r i e s o f f o r m a l l a n g u a g e s in Chomsky's s p i r i t .
simple
consolidate research
on
eliminate
the
objects.
This
to
probably for
of
the
theory
also
instance
with the
ANNEX
We g i v e
here
t-he
proofs
of
certain
t h e main t e x t . The numbering o f the text are THEOREM
the
t-heorems
formulated
t h e o r e m s and t h e i r
in
order
in
observed.
1.2
c
% r i * » p % r ^ Q % s v
•V V <:c
theorems:
I.2a
c C p , Q , 0 ^ CCr,s,xi> ^ t
*v=*pa;r/N<j5!;sv
V ^
CCv,s,qi'>
and THEOREM
1.2b
CCp,cj, O yN c C r , s , u ) ^ Cp % r -~. <j % s V V V
V cCp,v,r> /v c
o f T h e o r e m 1.2a.
Let
From Axiom 1.8 and t h e f o r m u l a Cl> we o b t a i n p % r V V CcCr,v,p) V c
p
is
Conclusion theorem
equlform
1.2 is
qf
true.
is
with
r,
equiform
Let
us,
then with
s
therefore, IS6
by and
assumption the
assume
thesis
Cl>
and
of
the
additionally
that
ANNEX
187
cCr,i> , p ) V C
case
when
CCr,t»^,p>.
It follows
from
<1> a n d Cl.l>
C1.2)
cCr,v
Further,
have
cCv^,q,v^:>
Hence, that,
by
Axiom
1.5,
that
tp") /v c C p , < j , t ) .
b y A x i o m 1.2, w e
C1.3>
^
c
formulas
b y C1.3> a n d A x i o m 1.7, i t
C1.4> and
the
C1.2>
follows
and
C1.3>
yield
tftt
so
that
CCr,v^,ty, since
cCr,s,ii)
^
t%u
by
assumption
Cl>,
by
Axiom
1.7
we
obtain C1.5)
cCr,s,ty.
In t u r n
<1.4> amd <1.5> a n d A x i o m s I . l a a n d 1.6
<1.6)
s
By the
applying
Axiom
relationship
thesis
of
from Since
analogical as
the
<1.7>. in
in t h e
We n o w p r o c e e d <1)
once
more
to
C1.3> with
and
C1.6)
Cl.l>
we
obtain
yields
c C r , u ,p> ^ CCv , < j , s ) .
immediately cCp,u , r ) .
%V
cCi> , q , s > , w h i c h t o g e t h e r
C1.7> The
1.7
yield
theorem Ve
that case to
under
have
still
to
case
the
proof
when cCr,v , p ) , i t
prove cCp,cj, O
consideration analyse
is
T h e o r e m I.2b. L e t ^
C
of
the
us
case
the
omitted
follows
thesis here.
assume
that
when is
18S
ANNEK
and C2>
p f t r ^ Q ^ s v ^
CC
v
v C
the first
element
of t h e disjunction
t h e theorem
follows
Immediately
us, therefore,
assume
from
C2> h o l d s
the
CD a n d Axiom
thesis
1.4. L e t
that
CCr,u , p ) y- CCu , q , s ) v c C p , v , r > ^ CCu , s , q > and c o n s i d e r
t h e case
Cl.l>
c C r , v , p ) /^ CCv
By a s s u m p t i o n s <1.2)
Cl> a n d Cl.l> w e o b t a i n
availing
ourselves
from
Cl.l>.
In t h e o t h e r
that
the thesis THEOREM
The the
,tf,sy.
CCr,^ , p > ys c C p , q , t ) ^ cCu ,«j,s> ^ C C r , s , u > .
By
of
when
of
Axiom
t5:u, w h i c h case,
I.S
concludes
when
cXp,v
we
obtain
t h e proof ,ry
^
i s analogical. I t i s t h e r e f o r e
immediately
for the
cCv ,s,q>,
omitted
the
case proof
here.
1.7
proof
of
this
theorem
is
by induction
with
respect
to
v a r i a b l e n. P
r
o
o
Definition
f
.
For n«l
the
1.2a a n d C o n c l u s i o n
theorem
1.3a. L e t
is
true
us, therefore,
Ac inductively Definition assumption
that I.2b, p.et*',
in
view
of
assume
k+i VGW and,
p e V, and
additionally,
<J-<sf', by
and
that
CCp ,<j ,r>.
Conclusion
I.3a,
re By «7-eV.
V. the By
Then,
by
inductive availing
ANNEX
189
ourselves
of
Conclusion
1.3b
k the assumption
we
have
reW.
Thus
it,
follows
from
h+i VSW t h a t
I'Sh', and s i n c e
the
theorem
is
true
immediately
from
f o r n"l i t i s t r u e f o r any n a t u r a l number n. THEOREM
1.8
p e P r o o f . Axiom It
I.IO
follows
p eV.
For
and
n"!
Definition
from
Since
V/\qi^p^qe
tf^p,
the
theorem
I.2a.
Assume
Definition by
v.
I.2b
Axiom
1.7
follows that
that
we
n>l,
p€ V
cCp ,p , p ) ,
obtain
and
(}%p.
V
and
p e
cCp ,p ,Q>. H e n c e ,
by
D e f i n i t i o n I.2b, «je V, which w a s t o b e d e m o n s t r a t e d . THEOREM
1.9
p e The
inductive
V ,^ q> e proof
I' .^ cCp,<j,r> ^ r e
of
this
theorem
K.
is
carried
out
with
r e s p e c t t o t h e v a r i a b l e n. P r o o f , view
of
inductively
Note f i r s t
Definition that
it
that
for
I.2a,b. is
n"l
Let
true
for
the
us, n^k
theorem
therefore, and
P e "V,
C2>
t
C3>
cCp,Q,r).
e
k+i
V,
By D e f i n i t i o n I.2b we o b t a i n f r o m C2>
C5)
Q2 ^ "'
true
that
in
assume
demonstrate
v a l i d i t y f o r nmk+t. We a c c o r d i n g l y a s s u m e i n a d d i t i o n CI)
is
its
190
ANNEX
C6>
CC«J^,
ourselves
of
Axiom
<8>
1.2 w e
obt.3iin
ccr^,q2''2* It.
Tollows
C4)
and
is
true
<7>
that,
for
Definition
By
from r e
I.2a
and
Inductive V.
n"l,
referring
<7> a n d
t-he
Since
the
C6>, i n t h a t
C8)
Theorem order,
CIO),
yield r e
Axiom
I.lb
and
find
CD,
consideration
the
formula
C5),
^
to
formulas
CSi
and
<:3>,
of
Theorem
and
that
r.
and
C9>,
V, which c o n c l u d e s t h e
THEOREM
formulas
under
conclusion,
1.2
r
theorem
and
yield
we
CIO)
Hence
the
above
formula
to
assumption
in
view
I;8,
proof.
I.IO
P r o o f .
We
shall
first
prove
a b o v e e q u i v a l e n c e i s r e p l a c e d by t h e T e ^^V The p r o o f
of
this
^
V p^ '^
lemma i s
the
lemma
in
which
the
impllcat.ion
V cCp,q,r). n,, '^'^' qe V
by i n d u c t i o n
with r e s p e c t
to
the
v a r i a b l e n. For
n^l
the
assume
the
truth
lemma of
the
is
true
by
lemma f o r
Definition rv^k.. We s h a l l
I.2a,b. prove
Let.
us
that
it
ANNEX
191
holds
for
n»k+l.
Assume
Derinltions
I.2b,a w e
accordingly
P, €
***V,
C2>
P2 e
*K,
of
the
inductive
assumption
C4)
<jj e
K,
C5>
q>2 «
*'''
We the
now
apply
labels
<j
Axiom
and t h e
1.2
to
the
a n d CI) w e
labels
concatenation
C7>
V.
By
of
<j^ a n d
again
to
have
p
and
<j_ a n d p . We
obtain
'='^92''*2''l*'
Now
r*r
and
C8>.
t e
K
of
re
have
<1>
a n d In v i e w
that
follows
Hence follows
from
Axiom
cC<j , t , r ) from
C4> w e c a n s t a t e
in
I.S
view
Theorem
and
formulas
C6>,
<8>
and
and
(5),
C2>
and
C7>,
in
view
t h e lemma i s t r u e
for
n«Aj we
have
1.9
Axiom
V
s h o w n i t s t r u t h f o r n"«At+l, which c o n c l u d e s i t s i n d u c t i v e
converse
easily of
the
Since
that
Thus on t h e a s s u m p t i o n t h a t
can
1.7.
C7)
of
It
C3>,
be
seen
lemma
that
proved
the above
implication is
also
proof.
which true,
T h e o r e m 1.10 i s t r u e by T h e o r e m 1.9 and D e f i n i t i o n I.2a.
is so
the that
192
ANNEX THEOREM
I.lib
P r o o f . suffices
t,o
By
p e If ^ Vi p e
V.
Theorem
pelf
deinonst.rat.e
t-hat,
I.lla, peV
•»
V
t^ p e V ^
p^v.
amn.
Hence
it.
proof
of
The
t h i s lemma will b e by i n d u c t i o n w i t h r e s p e c t t o t h e vau^iable n. The lemma i s pe y
and
ns^l,
true
for
nm\,
then
by
Definitions
I.2a,b,
the
one
hand,
be
Axiom 1.11 p, on word t o k e n s
concatenation results
in
lemma i s
of
a
any
for
If
it
would
could
pair
of Let
labels us
7i"At. We s h a l l
so
that
Convention
other,
would
(because
assume
prove
be
a concatenation
and, on t h e
contradiction.
true
for
its
1.3
and
of
two
not
be
p e V>,
inductively truth
pev,
for
a
which
that
the
n^k+i.
Let
accordingly
CD
P « "V,
C2>
p e By
Definition
I.2b,
we
**V. obtain
-
in
view
of
C2>
-
the
expressions <:3>
Pj e
'^y,
C4>
p^ e
K,
CS>
cCp^,P2,p>. Now
view
C55 of
therefore, the
yields
p«V
Definition apply
relationships
by I.2a.
Definition
Axiom Since L2b
to
I.ll, Cl>
and
hence
holds,
formula
Cl>.
also nOl.
Then
p« V We we
in can,
obtain
ANNEX
193
We n o w a p p l y T h e o r e m
1.3 fco C5>, <8>, < 4 ) a n d C7) a n d
C9>
p^ % t j ,
while
b y T h e o r e m 1.8 f r o m
C6) a n d < 9 ) w e
C10> now
we have
apply
the
THEOREM
T^W -^ | r |
-
n > 1 «*
in
the
*^'^'
- * - ^
carry
out
only
shadl
view
T^¥
of of
implication
demonstrate
because
from
that
consequent
PX^W
implication,
directly
accordingly and
|r \ -n-2.
Definitions the
implication
under
that
it
I.2b,a is
consideration
is
true
for
and
C3>.
demonstrated.
iQl
-
follows
from
Definition
Definition I.2b -
1.3
yields T^ e
I.3b
Then and
true. is
"V,
|r| and
J ^
Then
cCp,q,r».
inductive
converse and
by
1.3
and
true
proof
for
of
implication 1.7.
Definition
Assume
7»"/B+1. L e t
T ^ W and
in view o f
CIO)
be
an
the
Conclusions
and
tl> It
to
m^fc+1, w h i c h w a s t o
^A^
We
simple
follows
assumption
1.12
P r o o f . the
inductive
B»-l»/t, a n d h e n c e
obtain
"^V.
Pj e
We
C2)
obtain
Theorem
Assume 1.3 1.7
inductively n"!m>l.
2 re V
We
the that shall
accordingly
= m+l. Cl>
that
re
V,
which
-
194
ANNEX
Further,
in view
of
T h e o r e m I.IO, w e
C5)
t
€
y,
C6>
t^
e
"V,
C7y
have
c<.t^,t^,ry. The
inductive
and D e f i n i t i o n
and in view
Assume
assumption
yields,
in
view
of
<2>,
Theorem
1.7
^
or
1.3,
of
C6)
additionally
that
i+J"m+l.
Then
Ci-l!>+j«m
i-l>l
i + C J - l > " m /v j - t > l . Let above
us
consider
disjunction
Cl.l> In t h i s
first
the
holds s o Ci-1)+J
case,
a.2>
in view Pj,q^ e
of If ^
case
when
By a p p l y i n g
m m ^ i-1 <9>, w e IPjl
-
obtain
> 1.
have i-1
c
first
that
and <1.3>
the
^
iQjl
-
J
part
of
the
ANNEX
195
Cl-4>
CCtj,Pj,Uj5,
C1.5>
CCvi^,q^,u^>,
which
yield
r*u
in
view
a n d <1.5) y i e l d , b y A x i o m
of
C1.3>
and
C7)
and
view
of
Axiom
1.5.
This
1.7,
C1.6)
CC« ,<j^,r>.
Since
N . |"i
Conclusions
I.3a,b
|«j !•_/
g.elt'
C1.6>
and
and
ueV
and
1.7
in
in and
view
of
<5),
Definitions
C1.2>,
we
I.2a
can
<:i.2), and
st-at-e,
1.3,
<1.4>, and
considering
that
<1.7)
V
<|p|
-
i
^
1,1
-
J ^ cCp,<|,r)>.
p,
now t h e
C2.1>
second
i+<j-l>
By above
availing
ourselves
assumption
<:2.2>
case,
-
that
is
m />. jf-1 > 1.
of
formula
C8)
~ ^ ^
\
we
obtain
from
the
that
/>2,q2 ^ ^ ^
\P2\
'
-'"^
and C2.3>
CCp^,q2,r^>.
By a p p l y i n g
A x i o m 1.2 w e
have
C2.45
C<(t^,r2,-u^y,
C2.5)
CCp^jVjjV^).
By of
availing
C2.3),
C4>,
A x i o m 1.7, w e
ourselves C2.4)
have
and
of
Axiom C2.5>.
1.5,
Hence,
we in
obtain view
m^^u of
in <:2.5)
view and
196
ANNEX
C2.6>
C
It, follows Iv. |>J and
from
follows
C3:>,
C2.2> t.hat. p^eW and
from
Conclusions
Definlt.ions
I.2a
and
lp->l"ij
I.3a,b
1.3
and
and
whereas
1.7,
v.^W and
formulas
formula
C2.4>.
C2.2)
Hence
in
view of C2.6> we can st-at-e t,hat< <2.7>
^ ^ ^ <.\p\
Thus
for
the
-
i ^ 1«,| ~ j
assumption
that.
r. c
i+j«m+l
in
both
cases
under
consideration, i.e., Cl.lJ and <2,1>, we have p,^H' C|p| -
i" .N | q | - J
A cCp,<j,r)>,
and hence i^j i+j-m+l The l a s t of
the
p , ^ N ' *^l^l " ' '^ I*"! " J ^ CCp,<,,r».
expression
implication
proves
for
that
n"m>l
the
assumption
results
in
its
being
n"m+l. This concludes t h e inductive proof of t h a t THEOREM
» n+1 «*
P r o o f .
2
pe V
by
the
truth
true
for
implication.
1.13a
p G W ^ \p\
induction.
of
For
n"l
Definition
V
We
refer
the
expression
1.3
and
equivalent, by Definitions
to
c
the
principle
peh' ^
Theorem
I.2b,a, t o t h e
<.p ,p ,...,p _^,,p>.
1.7,
of
mathematical
\p\"2
is
equivalent
and
that
in
turn
to is
expression
p^,^3.K^<^l'''2'^^ Thus,
in
view
of
Definition
I.4a,
the
theorem
is
true
for
n»«l.
ANNEX
197
We sissume truth
for
that,
it
is
n«fc+l. For
equivalences
which
true that
for
n«At>l and s h a l l
purpose
follow
we
from
write
demonstrate
out
a
Definitions
its
sequence
1.3
and
of I.2b,
T h e o r e m 1.7, t h e i n d u c t i v e a i s s u m p t i o n and D e f i n i t i o n I.4b: k+Z «je*^K
^ft+2^'^
* ^
h+i. ** )( ^
It
^
follows
^
^
^v
from
^^
these
^Pi'P'>>- >Pb*t''*'^
equivalences
^ CCg,p
that
,p»
the
4^
Inductive
assumption Implies that the theorem under consideration is true for n™*+l. Hence the theorem is true for any natural number n. THEOREM
1.14
n+1,
^
n+1.
l
it
is
1.4a true
It that for
follows the
immediately
theorem
is
true
nmh. To d e m o n s t r a t e
f o r n»fc+l we a s s u m e a d d i t i o n a l l y Cl>
^i'*»i ^ '^ =• l < . < n + l from for that
Theorem n"l. it
is
that
C**2cp^,P2,. .,Pj^^j,Pj^^2'P' ^ '=**^'^'»1''»2' ''»*H-l'''it+2'^'
and
We s h a l l d e m o n s t r a t e
that
f'i
We
^ '^i 1.3
and
assume
then
true
198
ANNEX
l < i < k + 2 Pi. * " i In v i e w o f <1> it- f o l l o w s f r o m D e f i n i t i o n I.4b t h a t ,
and
By T h e o r e m 1.3, f o r m u l a s C4> and C2> yield
and ^*^
^fc^2 * In
view
of
t,he
theorem
''M*2
which
is
a
generalization
of
Axiom
1.7 Csee T h e o r e m I.15> f o r m u l a s C3), C5) and <2> y i e l d
-
I < t < * + 1 ''i-'^i ^ '''
w h e n c e by t h e i n d u c t i v e a s s u m p t i o n we o b t a i n
Since,, m o r e o v e r , <6!> h o l d s , we n o t e
that
l
concludes
consideration.
the
inductive
proof
^i' of
the
theorem
under
ANNEX
199
THEOREM
1.18
The p r o o f I s by lnduct.ion w i t h r e s p e c t , t o t h e v a r i a b l e n. P r o o f .
Note
immediately
from
therefore,
assume
first
that
for
n«l
the
Conclusion
1.2
and
Definition
its
for
n"fc
and
truth
theorem 1.4a.
demonstrate
h o l d s f o r n*iJt-t-l. F o r t h a t p t i r p o s e we a s s u m e a d d l t o n a l l y
follows Let
us,
that
it
that
and C2> and
p % «j, also
C3>
\ < J < Jit+2
and
It follows
from
Definition
I.4b a n d f o r m u l a
<1>
that
and «S>
•=<^'l'<'At+2'''^ '^ *=*^*2'*»*+2''»* Let
us
consider
now
two
cases,
we s e e ,
in view
namely
when
of
that
1<J<*+1. In t h e
first
case
C4>
Jmh-*-2
and
when
200
ANNEX
By T h e o r e m holds
from
1.17,
in
view
Conclusion
of
1.2
<5),
and
we
have
formula
'^*'o>
<6)
we
^nd
since
obt-ain
C2>
Pi,4.->^j,+o-
Thus <7>
J " >t+2 ^ p . % Q .. In t h e s e c o n d c a s e Ct<j
Hence, also,
by by
Conclusion the
1.2
inductive
p .%o . in v i e w
and
I
fofnailas
C2> and
assumption
and
C6>,
formula
f %t C5>,
Hence
we
have
of ^
D
Si a
.
i^J
Therefore C8) From t h e
implications
self-evldently for
n"k+l
is
that
1 < J < fc+l ^ p
:s q .
<7> and
formula
p . ^ . and
true.
This
C8> and
that
the
concludes
thesis
the
C3) we
of
obtain
Theorem
inductive
1.18
proof
of
p^W ^
P^I •
T h e o r e m 1.18. THEOREM
II.l
V n / - 0. P r o o f . Then,
in
view
Let of
us
aissume
Axioms
1.9
that
pe¥nl
and
II.l
so and
1.3 a, I.4b and 1.4 t> we h a v e o n e o f t h e f o l l o w i n g (1)
p ^ V ^ p e I , '^ o
that
Conclusions cases:
I.3a,
ANNEX
201
Cll>
p e
r\K
Clii)
p e
K /s p e
Civ>
p e
l«^K -N p e
Now
case
are
excluded,
II.4
and
follows
is
excluded
respectively,
11.11.
We
from
have,
Theorems
Civ),
Definition
1.2a
that
pe
pe
K
Theorems
/N p e
and
by
/\/
,
/\/
the
where
I.IO a n d I.IO , t h a t
-
Axiom Axioms
and
and
p^eK<^q>^e"^K-N
,
therefore,
I.ll
I,
by
/
11.6.
Cases
1.12
and
to
I.ll
-
and
there
are
in
view
p.,ct
^ q^ By we
applying
find
-
in
of Axioms
Axiom
view
of
I.ll and
1.8
to
the
the
fact
II.3 - that
that
by
contradiction proof
of
=
P<-PQ,P^,-
P r o o f .
I.IO
with
Theorem
CONCLUSION P
Axiom
that
Axiom
1 ^
p^^P^ 1
follows
p.el'
p^'^V
II.6.
This
^
Assume
q
"
P
••>Qj^> •*
that
<1>
P =
C2>
<j =.
P C P Q . P J ^ - .P„>>
pCq^,q^,...,q^)
latter
by
that
cCp ,<j ,p>
^
and
and
p^Gl
^
o P^^I 2
Po^^ >
concludes
II.l.
condition
cCp^,q^,pi.
1
II.3 .P^
I ^
P^^
and
It
follows,
such
2
2
Axioms
^
e
formula
it
Clv>.
the
Hence
€: I ^
and
the
to
,p^,
and
case
of
dual
n>l.
c
II.3
analyse
definition m>l
cCp
,q
in
,p) view
• Hence
it
o which the
is
in
indirect
202
ANNEX
and a d d i t i o n a l l y thatCl.l)
P % q-
Then by Axiom 11.10 f r o m f o r m u l a s <1) and Cl.l> we o b t a i n CI 2 )
«j -
pCr^,r^,...,r^)
and 0<>i
by
Axiom
II.9 t h e
k
"^k
function
p Is
a
one-to-one
function
f r o m C2) and t l . 2 ) we o b t a i n
" -*'
0
which by <1.3> y i e l d s ^'^'
0<^
^2*^
0
Then by Axiom 11.10 and f o r m u l a s <1>, <2> and C2.1) we h a v e C2.2>
q « P
w h e n c e by Axiom I.lb we o b t a i n C2.3> Since
P * 9 the
assumption
Cl.l>
yields
C1.5>
and
the
assumption
C2.1> y i e l d s C2.3> t h e p r o o f o f t h e c o n c l u s i o n i s concluded. THEOREM
II.2
S - n < X I 6CX) >. The proof of Theorem II.2 Is based on the two inclusions:
ANNEX
203
THEOREM
II.2a S
THEOREM
S: (^ < X
is
<5<:X>
>,
II .2b
n -t X o
I
P
r
o
f
of
to
be d e m o n s t r a t e d
Ca>
II.2a.
I 6CX) > S S.
In
accordance
with
Definition
II.4c
it
that
r e
U
S ^ A C6<X) ^ r e
X>.
fcaO
It
suffices
to
demonstrate
that
the
following
implication
holds: Cc<'>
r €
The
proof
Definition
of
II.4a,
true
for
by
be
is
reC ,
self-evidently implication
Ca'>
* S =* ^ <:<5CX> =» r € X>.
true
kml+i.
induction.
whence
the
Definition for
Assume
II.4b a n d C o n v e n t i o n
by
fe">f.
Cl>
shall
accordingly
II.3c w e r
fe»0,
consequent
II.5. We
For
re S
of
and,
Ca')
follows
Let,
therefore,
prove
that
that
re
S.
it By
by
is
the also
Definition
liave G
's
or C2)
7»^ > 1 ... r^,r^,..,r^
e
S ^ r
^ c
In
case
<1>
c a s e C2> we h a v e
Ca'J
is
true
by
the
•* p C r ^ . r ^ , . . . , ? ^ )
^
C c , C j , . . . , c ^ ,Cjj).
inductive
assumption.
In
204
ANNEX
C3)
n^ > 1 ^ r^,r^,...,r^
e
S
and C4)
r
and,
-
p(r^,r^,...,r^
> ^ C
Cc,c^,...,c^
b y C3> a n d t - h e i n d u c t - l v e a s s u m p t i o n ,
C5J
0 <6CX) •» r „ , r ^ , . . . , r X
Thus obtain
when from
O
X Is
any
C5!>
that
o b t a i n by D e f i n i t i o n In
both
cases,
Eissumption concludes P
r
that
the
o
o
proof f
set.
and
Cot'>
is
of
1
eX,
the
and
C2>,
it
true
for
This
(oi), t h a t
theorem
A <6CX> ^ r 6 X> ^ r
satisfies
the
<4)
we
the
inductive statement
is
to
the
equivalent
to
the
implication
6
U
S.
*-0 antecedent
Definition
following
we
of
This
is
^
with
from
Ifl+l.
<.ft>
accordance
view
£CX),
the
in
follows
to
that
condition
reX.
implication converse
Assume
have
X> ^ n^ > 1.
satisfies
r _ , r . ,...,r
Cl>
we a l s o
7*.
1
that,
11.5 t h a t
of
e
,c^)
II.5,
of r
C^>
is
true
so
is
in
any
set
that, X
in that
conditions:
r e x ,
CD
s
p n>l
In
order
to
PQ,P^,•••,P„«^ ^ C
<.a,a^,...,a 1
demonstrate
that
O 1 ,a_J ^ p e n o "^ At r« U S
fc-0
it
n X>.
suffices
to
prove
ANMEX
205
t-hat
t-he
it
"* k U S
set
satisfies
satisfies
condition
conditions
Cl>,
Cl>
" k E £ U S,
i.e.,
^
Definition
S^E . To demonstrate s condition C2> let us assume that
n > 1 ./v ^o'^i'-'^n
In
fact,
because
that
"" k
^
<2>.
by
Jlt=0
II.4a
<:3>
and
U
It
satisfies
S
and
By
C3>
number
I
we out
expressions
can of
state
the
Definition °° k p e U S.
>
1
II.4b
The
^
the
"* At U S
set
C/3> i s
e
P r o o f . Definition
C5>
and
satisfies
accordingly
the
pe
S,
have
C4!)
the
yield
required
condition
true.
II.4a us
The and
assume
true
for
k S ^ Q ^ p = * q e
proof
of
this
Conclusion its
k^l+l.
being
II . 4 a
true
the
for
accordingly
p €
'*^S
Q ^ P-
S.
lemma
Let
and <2)
of
S.
k
also being
order
II.3
p e
Let
the
natural
>i=0
<2). The I m p l i c a t i o n
k^O.
greatest
determine
PQ,P^,->P^
formulas
At-O
LEMMA
which
is
C n > l ) . T h u s b y L e m m a II.l w e n
whence
there
numbers
Pf.,p^,--,p
C5>
By
that
is
by
lemma
AE»{ a n d
Induction. is
true
demonstrate
By for Its
206
ANNEX
By D e f i n i t i o n
II.4b it. f o i i o w s
C3>
P €
from
Cl> t.hat.
^S
or
Po'^1'
Now
for
<3> t - h e l e m m a
assumpt^ion view
'^n^ S
in
view
of
follows C2)
o f C o n v e n t i o n II.3c, w e
and
immediat-ely
from
DeflnK^ion
II.4b.
t-he
induct.lve
For
C4),
in
have
<5)
n^ > 1 A r^,r^,...,r^
<6)
p -
e
S,
p
By A x i o m 11.10, <6> a n d <2> y i e l d <:8>
<j -
p<s^,s^,...,s^
)
and 0
C5> and C9> y i e l d ,
<10)
k.
by t h e I n d u c t i v e
n^ > 1 A s^,s^,...,s 1
By
k
Convention
Definition
II.3c,
0 it
1
follows
e
Since a t
the
same
time
*
S.
n from
II.4c and C o n c l u s i o n s II.2b and II.6a 0
assumption,
A
CIO), that
C5>
and
C9),
ANNEX
207
<12>
6
by
CD,
Lemma
follows
II.2,
from
C7>,
% a
C2>, Cll>,
Axiom <12),
II.8
and
Convention
Axiom
I.lb
and
find,
by
II.3c,
It
Conclusion
I.ll
that
In
view
that
Q€
of S.
inductive
C10>,
Hence
<8>
the
assumption,
and
C13>
lemma true
we
under
for
Definition
consideration
fc"l+l
also
in
is,
II.4b,
under
the
C4>.
This
case
c o n c l u d e s t h e i n d u c t i v e p r o o f o f t h e lemma. LEMMA III.l "s
P r o o f .
In v i e w
of
£• £ that
it
suffices
to
DCO.
C o n c l u s i o n 11.5b w e
<1> so
S £• S
DCO,
demonstrate "S
C2>
have
£
that
£•
holds. The
proof
immediately inductively it
is
pe cases
C2i
from that
true S.
of
Then,
CI ,2 ,3 >,
definition.
In
accordance
with
is
induction.
ntk.
Let
us
assume
listed
the
1°,
III.2b,
in
the
when
inductive
For
and
for
Definition
case
III.2a
true
n""k+l.
by
by
Definitions it
for
is
II.3c.
We s h a l l
we
C25
follows
us
assume
Let
demonstrate
for
that
have
one
verbal p e S,
n"0
purpose of
the
formulation formula
assumption.
In
that
C2)
case
2 ,
that three
of
that
holds p
in is
a
208
ANNEX
compound
expression
in
accordance
by
CD
is
in
they
Finally,
its
p^D~'^Cp:> from
II.3b>
is
an
scope,
inductive
to
be
belong
t,o
S;
aussumptlon
they
are
C,
and
Axiom
and
in
of
by
and an
DCL^.
and
operator,
its
in
case
II.3b,c, that
II.3c).
hence, it
is
by a
indexlcal
3 ,
by
pe£.
<2)
p
Axiom
Thijs
is
true
it for
III.2
P r o o f . lemma
being
thus
(Definition
Cl>
Definitions assumption
Cp>;
formula
Thus
At
assume
E
pcD
in
demonstrated.
p e
the
II.9,
expression,
III.la,b
in
the
that,
operator
all
hence,
element.s
by
consisting
and
n»fe+l, w h i c h w a s LEMMA
Hence,
Conclusions
expression and
follows
p
of
inductive
DCt).
3
III.l ,
compound
II.9,
in
case
Definition
the
(Definition
In
variable
with are
£• c
consisting
that true
The
is
proof
true the
for
k
S ^ q ^ p ^ q e
by
of
this
Definition
lemma
is
true
h^l+i.
For
for
that
S.
lemma
is
ni.2a
and
k^l
by
and
purpose
induction.
For
*i"iO
II.4a.
We
demonstrate
its
Conclusion shall
we
assume
additionally
that Cl>
p ^
'*'S
and C2>
g = p. By
three
Definition cases
holds:
III.2b
it
follows
from
<1)
that
one
of
the
ANNEX
209
p^.p^,...,p^^
S c
o In
case
Definition
9€
S
in
the
Is
S
III.2b.
by
proof of
in.2c.
III.2b a n d t o
expression
q,
on
the
of
III.3>, i s
also in
we
to
of
that
that
C4>.
Conclusion
the
the
consider
It
«je
S
suffices
II.6a,
Lemma
respectively, III.l
and
inductive
expression which
case
Pf^,p.,p~,p^ P
<4)
p^
<:5>
is
-
3 . In
such
In
to
Definition
assumption
p
that
the
e
*S,
p^C/t»p^, P3 * P j .
c
Ca,aj,a2>«o^-
that
that
P^
and <7>
fact
set
the
satisfies S
Csee
s"".
<3>
<^6^
C2>,
the fact
case
Lemma
of
expression
expressions
the
refer,
III.6,
with
Definition
sequence
in
II.4c,
strength
2 ,
have
of
of
formula
A x i o m III.2.
condition
Finally
an
II.3
to
assumption, proof
proof
Lemma
II.4b,
equiform i.e.,
of
the
the
Conclusion
make u s e
that
to
2 ,
Definition
Definition
Definition
inductive
case
inductive instead
the
In
analogical
and
Note
qf€
quite
merely, II.2
I+l
1 ,
and
case
there
is
a
210
ANNEX
It there
follows exist
from
Theorem
expressions
III.l
and
qf_,<J^,<J_ s u c h
formulas
C3>
and
C2)
that
and
formulas
that
and
It
follows
a n d <9>
from
the
Inductive
that
<10>
^^2 ^
It
assumption
follows
formulas
in
turn
'^
from
C5) a n d C9> t h a t
Axiom
there
Cll>
is
I.la.
Conclusion
a cj„ s u c h
III.4,
and
and
<9>
the
pei)Ct>.
This
and
that
Q^C/vyt}^
and C12>
,3
By
Axioms
I.lc,b
we
* P3.
obtain
from
<12>,
<6>
formula <13>
Qg a: qf^.
It
follows
formula
from
Cl>
and
III.l
that
C2) y i e l d , b y A x i o m II.8 a n d C o n v e n t i o n
<14>
II.3c,
6 % a.
Since, is
Lemma
also
III.l)
by
Convention
guaranteed
they
belong
making
use
again
on t h e
strength
of
of
11.3a,
Pn'P4>P-y
by
Definitions
to
the
Axiom
C9>, a t
set II.8
the
are
III.l D
and
formula
expressions and
CConcliision
Convention of
II.3c
the
II.3c
form
aoid
Cwhich Axiom
II.5b). we
By
arrive,
ANNEX
211
"^^
0
formulas
<7>,
(14)
and
C15)
we
obt-ailn,
by
Axiom
I.lb
a n d C o n c l u s i o n 1.11, C16>
c^Cb,b^,b2,b^>.
Thus in view
of
C17>
<8>, CIO), <11>, C13> a n d C16> w e V
c, -
p^Cq
^0'^1'^2'^3
have
,
u 1 z
S ^
z 3
and
in
accordance
with
Definit.ion
i+1 obtain *i«l+l
<j€
III.2b,
in
view
of
C17), we
o S. Thus a l s o
follows
from
in case
3
t-he t r - u t h o f t-he lemma f o r
t h e assumption
of
its
being
true
for
At" I.
The lemma i s a c c o r d i n g l y p r o v e d . Note in
also
case
which
3 ,
is
that when
equiform
i t follows peS
from
by
with
p
is
t h e inductive
Definition also
in
III.4, S
assumption an
because
that
expression
<j
f o r m u l a C17)
holds. THEOREM III.6a CI
fttsc) c
P r o o f .
The t h e o r e m
c
follows
immediately
from
Definition
III.Bd and LEMMA III.3
rCp/qi) s ^ r — s - ^ p ^ q , c
c
which will b e p r o v e d by i n d u c t i o n . For III.8a,
n">0 Lemma Theorem
III.3
III.3,
Is
true
Convention
on t h e s t r e n g t h II.3c
and
of
Definition
Conclusions
III.8,
212
ANNEX
11.12, and II.13b,c. Assume t>hat. for
n"l
jrCp/ij) s
and
r • s. c
We
have
t.o
demonstrate
that
P"<J-
In
accordance
with
c Definition they
111.8b
are
Definition
and
the
assumption
cases
III.8.
Note
1
a>nd
2 ,
that
in
case
expressions from the s e t consideration which
in
quite
substantiates
successive and
is
steps
II.4a,b,c TSCL,
and
to
in
Conclusions
to
Definitions
and
Conclusions
III.6
case
2 . We have
then
and
C2>
r,s
and there are s ,s ,s
verbal
comment
analyse
each
of
to
and r ,r ,r
s
are
of
suffices of
in
Lemma only,
III.2a,
the II.14b
are
TSC«*-L,
us,
in
Definitions which
II.4
valid
that
III.3,
therefore,
is, ni.2c,
consider
such that
p^<:r^,r^,rQ>
conditions Definition those
and
e s"
r the
proof
III.8bCl°), Let
after
the lemma now under
II.7,
analoga
<4> of
of
and
s ^ p Cs^.s^yS^y,
one
when
instead
<3>
and
r
It
III.8.
possible;
1 ,
TSCL.
II.6a
are
verbally
the
their
cases
described
to
proof,
to
two
, the proof
fttsc the
refer
respectively,
S
analogical
I
of
Cla>
, III.8b
conditions
Cb),
Cc),
holds. we
formulated
Before
have
to
we
in
proceed
note
that
the to It
ANNEX
213
follows
from
III.7a,b Since
that. s
formula -
the
r,
given
expressions
also
determined Definition
^A'^A
by
s
C3) -
Conclusion
C2> a n d D e f i n i t i o n s
Definition
and
unaanbiguously
C2>,
Note
<4>,
= ,r
and
determined
C3),
and
and
C4>,
have
their
Defintion
Definition
11.3b
and
III.4 a n d I I I . 2 c . V e a c c o r d i n g l y
have
that
the
accordance
the
form,
with
the
expansions
it
follows
conditions
Convention
expansions
from
tjl
of
and
II.3c
III.l ,
Axiom
s
from
in
view
and
r
<2>-C4>
m
s In
expressions.
follows
are
unambiguously,
Conclusions
well-formed
too,
since
r
and
well-formed,
that
III.4
^'^^
which
111.5b,
III.l*
are
II.9 of
are and
satisfied.
r
these
conditions
take
on
respectively,
and C7)
C Note
also
that
<:8>
rf
follows
Cc,c^,C2,c^:>.
from
% c
the
assumption
Clb>
and
Conclusions
to
conditions
11.12
and
11.13b. We
now
assume
proceed
first
Ca)
that
the
analyse following
condition
is
n.3c
that
it
follows dj=scj
'from
and
^^^^
C5>,
Conclusions
This
yields,
We
satisfied:
, j j % Sjj ^ p % r^j ^ S j * r^ . . s ^ * Then
and
III.8 by
r^. and
C8:>,
<;6>
Convention and
C7>
214
ANNEX
and
Theorem
1.17,
d^^ix: , U
in
view
III.8,
of
C5>,
11.12
and
and s i n c e
p*r-,,
U
Theorem II.13b,c.
III.3, Thus
c o n d i t i o n (a> i s s a t i s f i e d . Let us consider t h e next Cb>
«J^5»-, and
O
Convention the
II.3c
lemma
is
can
holds,
by
IlI.e
we
easily <5),
have
be
seen
b!>xi.,
in
view
of
Cb)
III.3,
aSix.
1
and
1
have
still
to
implies
Convention dtsx..
Conclusions for
n-1
Thus,
if
if
This
*
'i
s 5a",. II.3c
and
yields
Cb)
Conclusion
immediately
p^
11.12
and
t r u e f o r n"l i f c o n d i t i o n
and
1
Conclusions
pmq
condition
that
Theorem
have
c
true
g s: S j >s p 5: r^ ^ 0
we
U
II.13b,c.
Thus
the
lemma
is
satisfied.
demonstrate
that
p^
if
the
following
c
c o n d i t i o n holds:
ct ^ s^ ^ p ^ r^ ^ s^ ^ r^ ^ s^ ^ T^. Now
let
Convention d.ysc
in
psa-^,
we
hold.
II.3c
we
view
of
have
Then have
<8>,
p*(}
in
view
d^ix
and
C6>, C7) and
in
view
of
of
C5),
d.^ac , Theorem
CS!),
Conclusion so
that
III.8 we
1.18. S i n c e
Theorem
III.3,
assumption
of
and
obtain
tfiis
and
Convention
II.3c, and C o n c l u s i o n s III.8, 11.12 and II.13b. Thus Lemma III.3 i s t r u e f o r The
proof
being
true
quite
similar
assumption
for
of
of
the
fact
n"l.
that
n»At Cfc>0> r e s u l t s to
the that
proof lemma
D e f i n i t i o n II.14c i t s u f f i c e s
of
the
in i t s
being
Lemma
II.4
being
true
for
true for
that for
T»"fc+1,
n«At.
n««fe+l on
Instead
t o r e f e r t o D e f i n i t i o n 111.8c.
T h i s c o n c l u d e s t h e i n d u c t i v e p r o o f o f Lemma III.3.
lemma is the of
ANNEX
215
THEOREM I V . 4
i? •
n < X I x"<5?> >.
To p r o v e t-hls t h e o r e m it. s u f f i c e s LEMMA
t-wo l e m m a t a :
IV.l
y and i t s
t-o p r o v e
p,H,T
converse
LEMMA I V . 2
/ V < F s X / v _ / V _
P r o o f
Cp,Q e
X ^ CCp,q,F>
o f L e m m a IV.l. A s s u m e
Cl>
s
and additionally
= » r € X ) ^ s e X > ^ s e i ? .
that
e i?
that
C2)
7 S X
and C3>
_ l!^ _ ^ ^ ' ^ e X x^ c ' C p , q , r ) ^ F e X ) .
We h a v e It label
t o demonstrate
follows token
s
from such
<1>
C6>
Assume
that
e X.
and
Conclusion
s^ e
y
C45 w e o b t a i n ,
^ CK S X /«.
s
IV.4
that
there
is
that
C4>
From formula
that
/^
Cp,q e
by D e f i n i t i o n s
I.l a n d I . l a ,
X ^ cCp,q,jr> ^ r e X> ^ s
€ X>.
a
216
ANNEX
C7>
XQ
It.
can
eaislly
Csee D e f i n i t i o n In then
fact, it
< p
seen
I
that
p^y,
follows
then
e
X >.
X
satisfies
from
i"^
view
<2> a n d C7> t h a t
peX
the
condition
\<.X ')
[p]^*'^
of
Conclusion
IV.3
and
have
C8)
V S X If,
then have IV.2a
on by
the C7>
other [p]
and
^^ [ p ] ' [ ' * ] ' r ^ l •*• and
Conclusion
C7>, r e X
hand, [q] ^y IV.l)
we
^
belong
to
applying we
that
X
and
p,<}€X by
formula
obtain
frleX
and
c
Definition
<3>
Csee
so
IV.2
we
Convention
that,
X„ /s c C p , q , r ) ^ r €
p,«j,r From
assume
in
view
of
Hence
C9>
C6>,
C8> a n d
a n d <S> w e h a v e
CD
[p]
I.la>.
if
We t h u s
be
-
0 C9)
we
0
obtain
s e X . L e m m a IV.l h a s
s eX-, thus
satisfies In f a c t
to
the it
demonstrate
that
seW
it
from
C2>
Conclusions
in
view
of
<7>
proved.
^ r
e
suffices
c o n d i t i o n XCX> C s e e D e f i n i t i o n follows
whence
been
P r o o f o f L e m m a IV.2. A s s u m e t h a t ^ < V s X ^ _ ^ _ C p , 5 € X -N c'Cp,^,?)
In o r d e r
X„>.
X) * s
to
e
show
X).
that
W
IV.5>.
IV.3, IV.4 a n d I . 3 a
that
K c iP. I t cam a l s o
C3>
be proved
that
_ '^ _ Cp,q e P»9»r To
do
so
let
us
»? /s c"Cp,q,r> ^ F e JtO.
assume
that
p,
and
cCp,<j,r5.
Then
it
ANNEX
217
follows q
from
such
that
Convention label are
and
r
such
tokens,
1.3b,
and
been
proved.
Now
IV.4
P" [PJI
IV.2a
token word
Conclusion
hence
r.
^"'^
there
^[^i]"
Conclusions that is
rei?
formulas
that,
C I ) , <2>
and
there
is
<^tp ,<} , r ) .
Since
P^rQ^
IV.4.
imply
and
that
IV.2
token
<3>
p
and
a
Conclusion
tokens
it
^^'^
word
word
Further
^"[^4!
also
by
IV.l
are
in
view
Formula
that
follows
seW,
of
from a
Conclusion
C3>
has
what
yraes
thus
to
be
demonstrated. THEOREM
IV.22b
Cp P r o o f .
p
TO p r o v e
the
CI)
direct
p e We s h a l l
Cv>
demonstrate
P ^^"^
-
Ca,a^,...,a^,a^:>y.
implication
we a s s u m e
-
P
that
S.
that
r,>l
-
-
""
Po'Pi
K,"^
'
>P„>
-
P„« ^ _n+i^ - x-> .-. c Ca,a^,...,a^,aQ».
By such
Conclusion
IV.20
it
follows
from
Cl>
that
there
is
a
<j
that
C2)
p - [«,J
and C3>
<j It
two
follows cases:
from
C3>
and
e
S.
Definition
II.4b
that
there
may
be
218
ANNEX
Cl>
q
« *S
or
^ c
In case Conclusion
Cl> pm [q 1 in IV.20
and
Cv)
accordance is
true.
C6j,a^,...,a^,aQ».
with
C2) and hence
Consider
t-hen
case
pe S by Cii5. Now
C2>, Cii) and Convention II.3c yield
1
1 ^ c
C6^,c^,...,c^ ,Cjj) ^ n^ > 1,
Assume that.
It
follows
from
formulas
C6>,
<2>,
<4>,
Lemma
II.2,
Theorem
IV.16a, and Conventions II.3c and IV.3c t h a t
In
view
of
Conclusion
IV.20 and
formulas
C4) and
C6) we
see
that
Since r, ,r,.,...,j~
in
accordance
eDC'. >,
IV.17a t h a t
it
with
follows
Lemma II.2 and formula from
(6>
and
(S>
C4i and
",-1
and
Theorem
ANNEX
219
<9>
p " p<.7^,7^,...,T^ >. Further,
in
view
of
C7)
and
C4>
and
Conclusion
IV.6
we
obtain —n+1 C Ca,c
C10>
— ,...,c
— »c ) /\ n
> 1.
1 The follows Now the
t-rut-h o f
i n t-he s e c o n d <8)-C10!).
let
It
first
follows
hold.
constituent
immediately
therefore
the
Then t h e r e
is
is
of
the
from
second
to
be
of
two
possible
demonstrated
disjunction
Conclusion
constituent
a n n >1 a n d t h e
the
IV.20
of
and
the
following
s^,s^,...,s^
e
C2>
p = pCs^,s^,...,7^
then
Lemma
disjunction
formulais
— fc+1— pe S.
that
holds,
are
cases
p€
II.1. Cv>
If
k+i— S Let hold.
valid:
S,
> 1
and C3>
c^'*'^Ca,d~,...,d
In that
view
of
there
are
Conclusion s^,s.,...,s U
1
IV.20 such
n
,d„>.
1
71^
O
and
formula
<1)
we
can
state
formula
C4),
that
1 and
Since s
,s
,...,s
n >1 eOCt>,
T h e o r e m IV.17a,
and, we that
by find,
Lemma by
II.2
referring
and to
<2>
and
C5>
and
220
ANNEX
The from
expression Axiom
Theorem
II.9. By
applying
IV.16a w e o b t a i n
From
C5)
Conventions
By
p < s , s ,...,s
we
)
is
in
Convention
OCi.>, lV.3c
which
and
follows
referring
t.o
f r o m C6)
obtain
immediately,
by
Theorem
IV.16a,
IV.3c a n d I I . 3 c ,
referring
and t h e f a c t
to
that
Conclusion
n +1>1 w e
IV.6,
formulas
<7>,
C8)
and
<3)
obtain
n+1 C < t C p < : s ^ , s ^ , . . , s ^ » , d ^ , . . . , d ^ ,dQ>.
C9>
In that
view
of
pCs-.,s.,...,s •^ 0 1
Conclusion
Definition n
>e
IV.20,
S, we
II.4b
and
formulas
whence, obtain
in
view
— Ac+1— pe S,
<4> a n d of
C9> w e
formula
which
was
C6> to
find and be
demonstrated. THEOREM
rCpyay '^ ^
IV.26b
s ** s.r
e S ^
<« •
^. n>l
^ — — ^0'*!'
— ^r '*n^
pC?^,?^,...,*^) .^ F •
pC?Q,F^,...,r^) A
^ 0
^j
*jk - rj^».
0
The
following
list
of
equivalences
results
from
ANNEX
221
Definitions
IV.26a
and
II.14b,
Conclusion
II.6a,
Theorem
IV.17a
and C o n c l u s i o n s IV.19, IV.18 and II.7: FCp/Q) s
**
p,qyr,s
/N Tdp^c^^ s ) <•
*^ •
[P] '^ i
-
[<j] '^ r «
V^ s ^^ " [P] -^ ^ " [<»] ^ r -
''O'^l
k
k
p,tt,r,s
n>l
«J •
rVj]
0<j
'^
L^J
TQ , r J , . - . , r^eS
A T "
Frl
^
s
•
fsT
yv s , r
e
S ^
s
^ r - pCrp,r^,.,.,r^> ^ q « s^. ^ p % r^ .. «»
V
V 0
1
p C s ^ , s ,...,s
^Qj
s^ % r^)
0
y -^
71 ^
•
0
[s]
Ci}a:s.-Np%r.^ J J
S Q , S ^ , . . . ,s^eS
0
^
[ r ] /s s -
[s]
'n^^
^ r • pCr„,r,,...,r ) ^ r.^^^ 0 1 n 0<j<7i
k^J
[r] ^ s -
n>l
-
-
D
^
-
i
n
^
'^^''^
e
S ^
s
0<_/
.00<*
«». - i'^»
-
pCSp,s^,....s^)
J
J
> -N
*•
^
^
222
ANNEX According
to
the
above
list
of
equivalence
both
sides
of
the
IV.26a
and
equivalence under consideration are equivalent. THEOREM IV.26C r-
h+i
fe > 0 •»
Conclusion
r Cpytf'> s
and
Let
Axioms
^ 11.10
IV.l
Jb
s ** _y_ fc>0. and
We
r Cp/q> s and
refer
the
to
i
to
r, %r_ 1 2
follows
prove
».
Definitions
relationship
(which
I.lc>
I
(. r
from
the
-^ s^5i»_ 1 2
Definition
following
^
II.14b
list
of
equivalences and implications: Tc'p?qy
s
^ rCp/q>
-V
V
««
p.afr.s
s 4> p^q^r^s
c rCu/0*s
*"^ "
[p] •-- 5 " [ Q ] '^ r •
[r"] ^ s " [ s ]
^P "
[p] -^ 5 "
[r] .^ s -
/s u
qi = [cj] /v r «" fr] ^ s «
>>
[<»] -^ ^ "
«•
V
[ s ] xv rCvyti
cp «
[ s ] /^
fpl .^
s ^ v
t ,v
^ \
%,t^r,s
A rCu/t' ^ * '
^ 7 -
[f J LIJ
f" -
M
-
' -
^ " P,<J,v^,«/^ -
^ w (p/jjj^t » 1"^^ 1
^
[0
-
«• -
[p] - g -
V p,
[r] -
'
[9] - V -
'1
-
M
-
[x,J ^
^
^
ANNEX
223
.^ Cf "
[cfl
A T "
fr")
^ s
•" r « l
- ^^CP/<J>^1 > -» p , q , r y s , t , v
A rCv/O
S / ^ v % V / v t % t ^
[P] - 9 -
[9] - ? -
[r]
-
— k i /^ s " rs"] /s r C v / O s j^ u
follows
from
implications
that
Cr(p/<j>
implies
the
equivalence
right the
s
side
the
for
in
the
the the
above
list.
of
assumption
expression theorem
At>0
which
under
equivalences
is
the
the
and
expression
right
consideration,
side and
of that
in t u r n
i m p l i e s a n e x p r e s s i o n which i s e q u i v a l e n t t o jt+i— CrCp/cj> s. This concludes t h e p r o o f o f Theorem
expression
IV.26C. THEORFM
pC/vyq
IV.29
^ p e Vr ^ p m C— .-> -1
V
.^ r e C— .^ p e C—
In
the
following
proof
of
this
theorem
we
avail
^ p = r^).
ourselves
lemmata:
LEMMA I V . 3
t e C— ^ f = f f l .^ p « rpT =» f e C , which f o l l o w s f r o m Theorem IV.20d, D e f i n i t i o n II.12d and LEMMA I V . 3 '
7 e C^ ^ 7 -
[ f ] /^ p -
[p] -» t e C"
of
the
224
ANNEX LEMMA
IV.4
P which follows LEMMA
«- J
f r o m T h e o r e m IV.20d, D e f i n i t i o n
IV.3'
follows
P r o o f
of
the
and
direct
[P]
Definition
directly
from
IV.21a
and
Definition
implication.
Let
the
Conclusions
IV.21a. antecedent
"pCjvyq true.
IV.29 t h a t
In
view
there
<2>
of are
this
assumption
expressions p "^3]
^^^
p^,p^ 9 -
it such
follows
from
Definition
that
[P2]
stnd
In v i e w o f <4>
<3> w e o b t a i n P3 e
from Definition
Kr ^ P 3 e
III.l
C^^
and '''0''l''2
^
O' 1
2
P2
^ P 3 e C^^ ^ P 3 *
F r o m C 2 ) - C 4 ) w e o b t a i n , b y C o n c l u s i o n IV.24 a n d L e m m a C6>
of
implication
<1> be
'- -'
from
I I . 1 6 a , b . L e m m a IV.4' f o l l o w s
that
II.12d
IV.4'
P Lemma
[P]
p iB Vr
^ "p e C—. 9
r^>.
IV.4,
ANNEX
225
A s s u m e t.hat, Cl.l)
V
cF -
p ^ c F , r , r > y. r
T,r^,r^,r^
0
s
C--
1 2
9
^ p e C—
It. f o U o w s
from
Cl.l>
« -
<1.3>
s
C1.4>
p e C- , *2
C1.5)
p »• s .
are
view
of
^Q'^-I'^2'^3
C1.6>
C1.2) such
Jg - [*J
it
-^ p = r . >.
that
<:i.2>
In
^
'p^Cs^,'s^,s^y,
e
C-, 9
follows
from
Theorem
IV.28
that
there
that
- =2 • [*2] -" ^3 "
- ?^ - [ s j
[=3]
and
By L e m m a IV.3 i t
foUows
<1.8)
from s
e C ^
a n d b y L e m m a IV.3 i t
foUows
in view o f
from
C1.4>, C2> a n d C1.6)
that
*2
( l . S ) , C2> a n d C1.6> w e
a.lO>
obtain
Pg % S j .
But C5).
, ^2
"* Further,
C1.4>, C2> a n d C1.6> t h a t
formulas
Hence
C1.7>-C1.10>,
assumption
Cl.l)
taken results
Jointly, in
a
contradict
formula
contradiction,
and
226
ANNEX
t h u s t-he r o r m u i a -I
is
V Cr B p
true.
That, f o r m u l a ,
t h e implication under P r o o f
in
viev
of
<6>, y i e l d s
the
consequent
of
consideration.
of t h e c o n v e r s e implication. Let
CI)
p e
^ p 6 C-
FT
and ,— —00,— — — Cr « p Cr„,r^,r_) /s r e C— ^ p e C— /N p • 0 1 2 Q r_ '^
C2)
r^) 1
'^'''0'''l'''2 Assume t h a t C3>
-.
C4)
^ In
view
of
CD,
[ p ] /N q •> [<j] •* -1 Cp<:/v)q>).
Conclusion
t h a t t h e r e a r e p.rP^rP^
such
IV.24
p = [p^] ^ p^ €
C6>
p -
C8>
and
Definition
[Pg] - 5 -
C9>
and
[P2]'
C9>
Vr.
Pg e to
see
Vr,
a n d b y A x i o m III.3 a n d f o r m u l a s
referring
we
have -I
By
IV.21
that
C5>
By C4> and C6) we
in
Definition
III.l
and
obtain
formulas
C8>,
ANNEX
227
<7> w e c a n s t a t e
that
there
are
CIO)
S3 -
Cll>
s ^
<:i2>
,s
such
that
e
C
, *2
Pg a: s^.
Now
let
<14>
s
-
[53]
-
^Q -
[ s j
By T h e o r e m IV.28, T o r m u l a s <:iS>
s
It
follows
<:i3> a n d C14>
from
<1S>
Cp -
-
[ s j
-
=2 "
[*2]
p^C?Q,s^,S2^ IV.4
and
and
C16>
G C— ^ p e
yield
C2). T h i s c o n c l u d e s
THEOREM
Sj -
C14> a n d C10> y i e l d
Lemma
s
Now
-
formulas
Cll>,
C12>,
the
a
C—
formula
,s p =
s,.
which
is
in
contradiction
proof.
IV.30b
p<:pjj,p^,...,p^> .N pjj « O ^ c "
Cp » 'p^<.p^,p^,p^:>
< a , a ^ , . . . , a ^ , a j j ) > •-•
/>. P 2 «
s
^ PgC/vSp^
Po'Pi'P2'P3 -^ Pg P r o o f .
C6),
that
<16>
with
,s
e , P2
^ <:i3>
,s
p'^<s^,s^,if^>, e
p
s
TO prove
the
-3^ - ,., p^ ^ c C a , a ^ , a 2 , a Q ) ) .
direct
implication we assume
that
228
ANNEX
CO
p . It
follows
such
from
Cl> and
***S. Conclusion
XV.2S
that
there
is
a
<j
that
C2>
p - [<»^]
and J^+1
Thus,
in
view
t h e following
of
Definition
III.2b
and
formula
C3),
one
of
t h r e e c a s e s can hold:
Ci>
q^ e * S ,
Cii>
^^,
V
Po-Pj,
P
,P„e S ^ c
Ca,a^,...,a , a „ ) ) , 1 n o
-^ P3 * P^ -«• c Ca,a^,a2'"o In
case
,
Conclusion
— fe—
/>G S
IV.2S,
in
and
view
of
hence
C2)
the
and
in
accordance
disjunction
which
c o n s e q u e n t o f t h e i m p l i c a t i o n under c o n s i d e r a t i o n i s In c a s e the
Cii),
direct
the
proof
implication
being
proof
of
formula
IV.22b.
It
suffices
merely
of
Conclusion
IV.20
in
and
and a l s o t o make u s e o f Let
us
of
accordingly
the
fact
proved
is
case to
to
Cli>
refer Lemma
that true
of to III.l
the is
the
the
true. consequent
modelled
proof
Conclusion Instead
is
with
on
of the
of
Theorem
IV.25
instead
of
Lemma
II.2,
view
of
Axiom III.2 and Conclusion IV.23. consider
case
Ciii>.
In
ANNEX
229
C o n v e n t i o n II.3c a n d Cill) w e C4)
q^ -
It
p
follows
Definition
from
III.l
we
r
^0 "
and
follows C3)
formulas IV.Sc w e
C4>
5 ^ ^^'^f^^^2
that
[^o] from
and C6>
9 j " P <:r_,r , r >.
e
O /s r
e
^ 'l
"
•" ^ 2 "
Conclusions
Lemma and
[^ll
,
III.l
Kr A r
e
Hence
by
£.
Theorem
['2]
III.la,b
that
r
IV.16a
'^ ^ 3 "
aind
['3]
II.5b,
formulas
C5>
Hence
by
II.3c
and
, r , r , 4 eD
^ ^2~
•=0 " t o ] '^ ^1 • t J In
view
state
that
of
Theorem
IV.28
and
Conventions
view
of
Definition
IV.29
[''2] ^ " " [**!]
formulas
F r o m C o n c l u s i o n IV.2S a n d f o r m u l a s
in
'l
have
<7>
and
'^ ""s *
that
<*' It
r^ e
have
C5) Note
have
and
Formulais
formulas
TgCTuSr . C4> a n d C6> y i e l d
C2>
C6) a n d C4> w e
have CIO)
(65,
immediately
C6)
and
C4>
we
C4>
we
obtain
and
230
ANNEX
Further a n d C4>
Now the
conclude
formulas
Ciii>.
Definition
IV.8
and
formulas
C7>
of
the
taken
Jointly
implication
concludes
the
allow
being
proof
us
proved
of
the
to is
state also
direct
that
true
in
Implication
IV.30b.
prove
disjunction
the
converse
which
consideration must
C8)-C12>
This
Theorem To
from
that
consequent
case of
we
is
is
implication
the
true.
right
Hence
side
one
of
we of
the
aissume the
that
the
theorem
following
under
three
cases
hold:
XJ^+I^
(.***->
_
_ V^
_ *^? "
-
p"*^^o'^l'^2"* "^ ^ 2
—
"^
^
^3*^^-*^2
P j '^ C
S in each of these
It must be demonstrated that pe
^
'^ ^ ^ ^ ^
—^
'^ P 3 •
^
^^
three
cases. In and
case
Cv>.
— h-*A—
pe
Definition
analogical we
C*>
to
assume It
III .2b.
the
the
S
proof
truth
suffices
to
follows The of of
immediately
proof the the
refer
of
left
to
— >t-H— p« S
side
second
from
of
in
case
Theorem
constituent
Conclusion
Conclusion
of
IV.25
<*•>
IV.22b
IV.25 is when
disjunction instead
of
ANNEX
231
Conclusion
IV.20
and
to
Definition
III .2b
Instead
of
Definition
II.4b, and a l s o t o make u s e o f C o n c l u s i o n IV.23. C o n s i d e r now c a s e (••*>. Then we h a v e
<1>
P - i°"<^*o'*l'*2'*'
C2>
s^
e
<3>
*S,
s^CjG>s^,
C4>
.3
By
Theorem
IV.28
it
-
.^,
follows
from
Cl>
that
there
are
Conclusion
IV.25
*0'*1'*2''*1 ^""^^ t h a t C6)
=^0 " C*o] ^ *1 " [ ' J ^ ^2'
1^2^
and
By
formulas
<3>
and
<2>,
Definition
and Lemma 1II.2 t h e r e a r e s^.s^ s u c h 4 4
IV.29,
that
^2 - [*43 " ^3 " [^5]
^8^ and
5
It
follows
from
C6)
and
4
C8>
4
that
'o**^?
and
hence,
if
we
assume t h a t (10) then
p^ -p"CSjj,s^,s^>, by
C7>,
Axiom
I.la
and
Then i t f o l l o w s f r o m C7) t h a t
Conclusion
III.3
we
have
p Sip
232
ANNEX
CIO
p -
[pj.
I t a l s o f o l l o w s from <4>, C8> and C6> t h a t <12>
* g S. *^.
It
can
belong
to
easily DC L >.
be
seen
Hence
II.3c and in view o f
In
By
availing
the
accordance
expressions
with
Conventions
^ri'^i'^a.'^-? IV.3c
and
Cll), C6), <8> and Theorem IV.16a we have
- M
CIS)
that
- '^o - C''o] - ''i - K ] - '^2 - M
ourselves
of
Conclusion
IV.6
we
obtain
III.2b
and
formulas
S,
whence
from
C5)
and C13>
By C12> and
referring
and
C14>
formula
The p r o o f
we
Cll>
to
Definition
find we
that
have
h a s t h u s been
p e
— k+l— pe S, completed.
which
was
by to
C10>,
Conclusion be
C9), IV.25
demonstrated.
NOTES
only. theory
When A
speaking
formalized of
C2>
<:3>
The
C1981b]
read
dedicated
here
at
the
the
27th
works
word
of
graphic
languages
languages
Can
axiomatic
[19671.
"part"
in
the
sense
drawn
in
my
paper
of
Logic,
11927-311.
TSCL w a s
Conference
of
mean
by T.Bat6g
mereology
outline
we
phonic
the
Le^niewski's
essential
to
of
was presented
interpret
from Stanisiaw
languaiges
t-heory
phonology)
We
about
presented
on
Kazimierz
the
History
AJdukiewicz,
on
October
16,
1981. C4>
See
M.J.Cresswell <;5>
The
for
instance
£19611,
Y.Bar-Hillel
[1964],
[1973,19771. definition p e
is
J.Lambek
dual t o
Definition
<6>
See
for
/
=• <\p\
« n «» p e
7)
1.3. instance
R.Montague
[19701,
M.J.Cresswell
1 1 9 7 3 , 1 9 7 7 1 , A . N o w a c z y k [19781. <7> OCt> i s
We
shall
later
a non-empty
C8>
See
for
demonstrate
Csee
Conclusion
II.9d>
that
set. instance
T.Kubirtskl
[1959],
B.Diankov
[1974,
19791. <9>
See
for
instance
K.AJdukiewicz
[19351,
Y.Bar-Hillel
[19531. <10> guarantee
Note
in
that
connection
with
compound
words 233
this in
that JP
Axiom are
II.9 its
does
not
compound
234
NOTES
expressions.
Hence
there
an
which
we
are
not.
and
its
arguments.
index
the
In
main
functor
w h i c h ax-e
structurally
Cll)
These
C12>
See
C13)
may
are
K.AJdukiewicz for
in
able
£
such
words
unambiguously We
mean
which
to
have
distinguish
here
expressions
ambiguous.
definitions
See
occur
given later
on in t h i s
chapter.
tl93S].
instance
M.J.Gressweil
[1973],
p.71
and
C1977]
p.258. C14)
Cf. R . S u s z k o C19S8], p . 2 3 6 .
C15> next
An
essentlatl
chapter.
(not
very
The
use
adequate
a
differs
LeSniewski's
mereology. Cf.
these
intuitive
AJduklewicz>
C16>
of
sense
definitions of
translation
from
the
K.AJdukiewicz
the of
meaning
119601
is
word the
of
and
the
made
in
the
"constituent"
term
used
by
word
"part"
in
W.Marclszewskl
l\977,
1978a]. C17>
Not n e c e s s a r i l y
<18> the
We
zero
can
order
<19>
adopt
of
Cf.
unambiguous.
the
the
convention
expression
J.Stupecki,
that
p occupies
K.Halkowska,
the the
constituent
of
p o s i t i o n O.
K.Pir«5g-Rzepecka
[1976]
p.278. C20)
Cf. P . D e m b l r t s k l , J . M a i u s z y r t s k i
C21> section. and
Examples Those
hence
compound derivation
of
trees
concrete
trees have
as
labels
expression tree
are
Csee
p
is for
to
their
<see a
[1981], pp.11-2. be
found
elements
Figs. graphic
instance
further
in
expression
II.1-II.6).
Tree
illustration J.E.Hopcroft,
this tokens
I of
of
a the
J.O.Ullman
NOTES
235
C1969])
treated
as
a
Is
set.
all
those
t-he
Definition
of
II.12>,
and
subordination formula
q—•r
the
linear
CC ,—•>, P
relation
p
of
can
of
of
graph
p
which
relatvon
easily
p which i s
the
the
all
are
might
of
of
(.C ,—•>, are
of
Its
where parts
direct
[19601>,
be
elements
set
defined
C Csee
syntac
Its
the
that the
part
tree
tical
by
I
nodes
ordering
relation
formal,
formulated
its
of
constituents
parts;
termed
be
of
those
its
position.
definition element
ordering
which
the
ordering
which
tic
is
a
the
^ QGC .
consisting
expression
syntac
an
as
K.Ajdukiewicz
4* q , r e C
Such
namely
elements
—y
Csee
C22> to
graph,
is
of
the
tree
of
a
given
is of
done
we
occupies
in
a
earlier
complicated,
consider it
by
an
somewhat if
related
that
every
a
fixed
syntactic
of
one
argument.
position. (23) They
Such
operators
include,
operator,
the
e.g.,
are
ordinary
algebraic
such
also
tfor
p.22>.
For
discussed instance
o p e r a t o r s of two C24>
The
Some
quantifiers, symbol
operators
those
the J] of
,
description the
integral
n att>guments
are
Tt>l>
<see
L.Borkowski
C1958,
19703
quantifiers
with
restricted
range
are
arguments.
symbolic
formulation
of l i t t l e p r a c t i c a l u s e , i s o m i t t e d <25)
operators
summation
s y m b o l S, e t c . Next t o being
called
comments
on
that
of
this
definition,
which
is
here. matter
are
to
be
found
both
the
in
my
p a p e r [1983b], p p . 3 0 8 - 9 . C26) TSCL
of
As we h a v e s e e n ,
TETk i s
simple
languages
categorial
the
core
and
the
of
theory
theory
TSCc»-L
of
236
NOTES
a>- I a n j ^ u s f ^ e s . (27) the
Conventions
sets
Tb,
I,
IV.2a,b,
IV.3a-c>.
<28)
This
theorems
of
(29)
For
definition
E,
is
dual
of
length
am a b s t r a c t
(305 sequence
why
The
verbal
will o f t e n of
later
be
range
<see
Conventions
of
over
induced
omitted. we
/>,
is
It
which
rormulations
precision
pe
1.3.
variables
given
the
«^
Definition
the
are
sake
•* C\p\mn
analogon of
2
theories the
p^I
concerning
which defines
add
to
TETp
the
by
the
dual
concept
of
the
induced the
index.
expamsion
of
P/^yp^f-,P
of
word
The
expressions
the
expression
types
of
P^Pf.,p^,--,p
which
that
5
is
the
expression
consists. <31> analogically
rCpycfys.
to
the
r
corresponding
and
T
expressions
are
rCp/q)
read s
and
REFERENCES
AJDUKIEWICZ, K. tl934]
W
sprawie
-unitosTsaliAxif
CConc&ming
Univsrsalsy,
P r z e g l a d F i l o z o r i c z n y , No.37, pp.219-34. [1935]
Die
syntaktiscfio
Leopoli, Connec
Konnexitat,
Vol.1,
tion,
pp.1-27. in:
Studia
English
McCall.
Philosophica,
translat-ion:
S.
Ced.),
Syntactic
Polish
Ixtglc
1 9 2 0 - 1 9 3 9 , O x f o r d 1967, p p . 2 0 7 - 3 1 . [I960]
Zwicizki CSyntac
sk.tadTiioxiie' tic
Relation
Sentences^, First.
mi^dxy
Between
Studia present-ed
Linguistic
cetonami Elements
Filozoficzne, in
Symposium
English in
xdaVt.
Erfurt,
osiTiajmujt\cych.
of
No.6
at,
Declarative C21>,
t-he
pp.73-86.
International
September
27
-
October
2 , 1958. BAR-HILLEL, Y. [1950]
On Syntactical
Categories,
Journal
of
Symbolic
Logic,
Vol.15, pp.1-16. R e p r i n t e d in: [1964], pp.19-37. [1953]
A
Quasi-ari
thmetical
Description,
Notation
Language,
Vol.29,
for pp.47-58.
Syntac
tic
Reprinted
in:
[1964], pp.61-74. [1954]
Indexical
Expressions,
Mind,
Vol.63,
pp.359-79.
R e p r i n t e d in: A s p e c t s o f L a n g u a g e , J e r u s a l e m , p p . 6 9 - 8 8 . [1964]
Language Theory
and
and
Information,
Application,
R e a d i n g , Mass.. 237
Selected
Addison-Wesley
Essays
on
Publishing
their Co.,
238
REFERENCES
BAR-HILLEL, Y., GAIFMAN, C , SHAMIR, E. [1960]
On Categorial of
Ihe
and
Phrase
Research
Structure'
Council
of
Grammars,
Israel,
Bullet.ln
9F,
pp.1-16.
R e p r i n t - e d in. t l 9 6 4 ] . BAT<SG, T. [1967]
The
AxiomaClc
Met-hod
in
Phonology,
Routlege
A KCegan
P a u l LTD, London. BOGHENSKI, I. M. [19491
On
the
Syntac
t ical
Categories,
The
Nev^
Schoolmen,
Vol.23, p p . 2 5 7 - 8 0 . BORKOWSKI, L. tl958]
On
Proper
Quantifiers,
Studla
Loglca,
Vol.VIII,
pp.
CA Theory
of
65-130. [1970]
L o g i k a F o r m a l n a CPormal L o g i c ) .
Warszawa.
BRYLL, G., MIKLOS, S. [1977]
Teoria
konkretnych
Concrete
and
Teachers'
i
abstrakcyjnych
Abstract
Training
Words>, College
sttiw
Publicat.ions of Press,
the
Mathematics
Opole Series,
Vol.XX, p p . 6 3 - 7 6 . BUSZKOWSKI, W. [19n2a]
Lambek's University,
[1982b]
Cat.egorial
Grammar,
Adam
Mickiewicz
Poznart.
Compatibility Associated
of
a
Categorial
Category
mathematische Vol.28, p p . 2 2 9 - 3 8 .
Logik
Grammar
Systems, und
Grundlagen
with
Zeitschrift der
an fUr
Mathematlk,
REFERENCES
[1982c]
239
Some
Decision
Categories,
Problems
in
Zeitschrift
the
fiir
Theory
of
Syntactic
Mat-hematlsche
Logik
und
O r u n d l a g e n d e r M a t H e m a t l k , Vol.28, p p . 5 3 9 - 4 8 . [1984]
A Note t.he
on
the
Secllon
Lambek-Van Logic,
Benthem
Polish
Calculiis,
Academy
of
Bulletin Sciences,
or
No.l3,
pp.31-37. [1985]
Algebraic
Models
Weingart.ner
P.
of
Categorial
Ceds.3,
Grammars,
Foundations
in:
of
Dorn
Logic
<3., and
L i n g u i s t i c s : P r o b l e m s a n d t - h e l r S o l u t i o n s , New York. [1986]
Typed
Func torial
Academy
of
Languages,
Sciences,
Bulletin
Mathematics,
of
the
Vol.34,
Polish
No.7-8,
pp.
495-305. [1987]
Generative Bach
E. a n d
Power
of
Wheeler
Categorial
Grammars,
in: O e h r l e
D. Ceds.>, C a t e g o r i a l
N a t u r a l L a n g u a g e S t r u c t u r e s , D. R e l d e l ,
Orammars
R.,and
Dordrecht.
BUSZKOWSKI, W., VAN BENTHEM, J., MARCISZEWSKI, W. < e d s . ) [1988]
C a t e g o r i a l Oraininar, B e n j a m i n s ,
Amsterdam.
GARNAP, R. [1937]
The Logical S y n t a x
of
Language, Harcourt
a
K e g a n , New
York. [1942]
I n t r o d u c t i o n t o S e m a m t i c s , C a m b r i d g e , Mass..
CHOMSKY, N. [1957]
S y n t a c t i c S t r u c t u r e s , M o u t o n a n d Co., T h e H a g u e .
GRESSWELL, M. J. [19731
L o g i c s a n d L a n g u a g e s , M a t h u e n , London.
240
REFERENCES
[1977]
Cat&gorial
Languages,
Le:^nlewski's
in:
Systems,
Surma
Studia
S.
J.
Logica,
Ced.>,
On
Vol.XXXVI, N o . 4 ,
pp.257-69. CURRY, H. B. [1961J
Some
Logical
Jakobson C1963]
R.
Foundations
Aspects
of
< e d . ) 119611, of
Grammatical
Structure,
in:
pp.57-68.
Mathematical
Logic,
McGraw-Hill,
New
York. DEMBIlflSKI, P . , MALUSZYraSKI. J . [1981]
Matematyczne
Metody
Programoitrania
Definlowania
(Mathematical
Methods
J^zykAw of
Defining
Programming Languages), Warszawa. DIANKOV, B. [1974]
An
Attempt
to
Ajdukiewicz's
Index
Hetalogical No.4, [1979]
and
HetKod
Calculus,
Ruch
Extension
and
the
Corresponding
Pilozoficzny,
Vol.XXXII,
pp.283-88.
A New Approach the
General iaiat ion
to
Corresponding
Landscape
the
AJdukiexoicz' s
Hetalogical
(Proceedings
International
of
Association
Index
Calculus,
the for
First
Hethod
In: A
Semiotlc
Congress
Semiotlc
and
Studies,
of
the Milan
1974>, The Hague-Paris-New York, pp.516-20. FREGE, G. [1879]
Begri/fsschri/t, Formelsprache [1964].
eine des
der
reinen
arithmetischen Denhens,
nachbildete
Halle. Reprinted in:
REFERENCES
C1964]
241
AngelelU
I.
<ed.>,
Aufsatze,
Begrif fsschrirt
Vissenschaft.Uche
und
andere
BucheeseJLlschaft-/G.01ms,
Darmst-adt/Hildesheim. GEACH, P. T. [1970]
A
Program
for
Reprint^ed
in:
Syntouc,
Davison
Synthase,
D.,
Herman
o f N a t u r a l L a n g u a g e , D.Reidel,
Vol.XXII,
H.
<eds.),
pp.3-17.
Semant-ics
Dordrecht.
GROSS, M.,LENTIN, A. [1967]
N o t i o n s sOr l e s O r a i n i n a i r e s P o r m a l l e s , P a r i s .
GRZEGORCZYK, A. E1981]
An O u t l i n e
of
Mathematical
Logic,
Warszawa-Dordrecht-
Boston. HIZ, H. [1957]
Types
and
Environments,
Philosophy
of
Sciences,
Vol.24,
p p .213-20. C19601
The
Int-uitions
of
Grammatical
Categories,
Methodos,
Vol.XII, No.48, pp.1-9. [1961]
Congrammaticali Grammatical
ty.
Bat teries
Categories,
of
in:
Transformations
Jakobson
R.
and
<ed.>
[1961],
pp.43-50. [1967]
Grammar
Logicism,
Reprinted
in:
The
Monist,
Buszkowski
W.,
Voi.51, Van
pp.110-27.
Benthem
J.,
M a r c i s z e w s k l W. C6ds.> [1988], p p . 2 6 3 - 8 2 . [1968]
C o m p u t a b l e and
Uncomputable
Rootselaar
Staal
and
B.,
Philosophy
Publishing,
Amsterdaun.
J.
F.
Elements
of
Ceds.>,
Logic,
Science,
Vol.3,
Syntax,
in: Van
Methodology North-Holland
242
REFERENCES
HOPGROFT, J- E., ULLMAN, J . O.
119691
Formal
Languages
and
their
Relation
to
Automata,
A d d i s o n - W e s l e y P u b l i s h i n g Co., R e a d i n g , Mass.. HUSSERL, E. tl900-l]
Logische
Utersuchungen,
Vol.I,
Halle
1900,
Vol.11,
Halle 1901. JAKOBSON, R. ted.> C1961]
Structure
of
Proceedings
Language of
and
its
Symposia
Vol.XII, AMS, P r o v i d e n c e , R h o d e
in
Mathematical Applied
Aspects,
Mathematics,
Island.
KUBIKISKI, T. [1958]
On
Extension
of
(/le
Acta Universltatis
Theory
of
Syntac
t ic
Categories,
W r a t i s l a v i e n s i s , No.12, pp.19-36.
LAMBEK, J. C1958]
The
Hathemfatics
of
Sentence
Sti-uc ture,
American
M a t h e m a t i c a l M o n t h l y , V0I.6S, pp.154-70. [1961]
On
the
Calcul-us
of
Syntactic
Types,
in:
Jakobson
R.
<ed.) [1901], pp.166-78. LESNIEWSKI, S, [1927-313
O
podstawach
matematyki,
Vols .XXX-XXXIV. Foundations
English of
Przegl^d
Fllozoflczny,
translation:
Mathematics,
Topoi,
On Vol.11,
the No.l,
pp.7-52. [19291
Grundziige
eines
neuen
Systems
der
Grundlagen
Mathematik,
F u n d a m e n t a M a t h e m a t i c a e , Vol.14, pp.1-81.
der
REFERENCES
243
C1930]
Uber
die
Grundlagen
stances
de
la
der
Soci^t,^
Ontologie,
des
Compt.es
rendus
et.
Let-tres
Sciences
des
des de
Varsovie, Classe III, Vol.XXIII, Warszawa, pp.111-32. LEWIS, D. [1970]
Oent-ral
S&mxnt ics,
Reprinted of
in:
Synthese,
Davidson
D.,
Herman
Vol.XII,
pp.18-67.
Ceds.),
Semantics
H.
N a t u r a l Language, D.Reidel, D o r d r e c h t 1972.
LUKASIEWICZ, J. [1929]
Elements Cfirst
of
Mathematical
Logic,
Warszawa-Oxford
1963
published in Polish in 1929>.
MARCISZEWSKI, W. [1977]
Opis
synta.ktycs:ny
kategorialnej in
mowy zaleAn&J
CSyntac tic
Categoriai
na
grxincie
Description
Grammar),
Studia
of
gramatyki
Inctirec
t
Semiotyczne,
Speech. Vol. VII,
pp.206-26. [1978a]
A Syntac
tic
Categoriai
Description Grammar,
of
Oblique
Revlsta
Speech
Brasiiiera
in
de
Terms
of
Linguistica,
Vol.3, No.l. [1978b]
On
Categoriai
inroduction> Formal
Grammar in:
and
Logical
Marciszewski
Languages,
Studia
Form
W.Ced.>,
Logica,
^editorial
Studies
Vol.XXXVII,
in No.l,
pp.l-S. [1981]
Ced.)
Dictonary
Language: Nijhoff,
of
Logic
Concepts,
The Hague.
as
Applied
Methods,
to
the
Theories,
Study
of
Martinus
244 tl989]
REFERENCES Tovtard
Universal
Grammcrrs
ContribvitioT\s, Circle
in:
and
Publishers,
Carnap's
Szaniawski
Lvov-Warsaw
and
K.
Ajdukiewicz's
Ced.>,
School,
The
Vienna
Kluwer
Acsdemic
pp.87-112.
MARKOV, A. A. [1954]
Teoria
Algorlfmov,
Lenlngi^ad.
Izd.
English
Akad.
Nauk
-translation:
Algorii.hms, S.Mouson,
Jerusalem
SSSR,
The
Moskva-
Theory
of
1961.
MONTAGUE, R. tl970]
Universal
Grammaur,
Reprinted [19733
The
Thomason of
Hintikka
Approaches
Dordrecht. [1974]
Treatment in:
Ceds.>,
Richard
Vol.XXXVI,
pp.373-98.
i n : [19741.
Proper
English,
Theorla,
Reprinted R.H.
Ced.>,
of
Qxtantification
J.,
Moravicsik
to
Natural
in J.M.E.,
Ordinary Suppes
Language,
P.
D.Reldei,
in: [1974]. Formal
M o n t a g u e , Yale
Philosophy:
Univ. P r e s s ,
Selected
New H a v e n ,
Papers Conn..
MORRIS, C. S . [1938]
[1946]
Foundations
of
the
Theory
Encyclopedia
of
Chicago
Chicago, 5 t h
Press,
Signs, Language
Unified
and
of
Signs,
Science, ed.
International
Vol.1,
No.2,
Univ.
of
1947.
Behaviour,
New
York.
NOWACZYK, A. [1978]
Categorial in:
Languages
Marciszewskl
Studia
Logica,
W.
and Ced.),
Variable-Binding Studies
Vol.XXXVII, N o . l ,
in
pp.27-39.
Operators, Formal
Lamguages,
REFERENCES
245
P E I R C E , CH. S . [1931-33]
Hartshorne Charles
C,
Weiss
Sanders
P.
Peirce,
Ceds.>,
Collected
Papers
Vols.1-5, C a m b r i d g e ,
of
Mass..
P E L C , J. C1967]
A
Functional
Natural
Approach
Language,
Hague-Paris
in:
1970,
to
the
Sign,
pp.89-112
Logical
Semiotics
l^anguage,
Cfirst
of
Cul-ture,
published
in
The Polish
in 1967>. [19711
Studies
in
Functional
Logical
Semiotics
of
Natural
System
Vithout
L a n g u a g e s , Mouton and Co., The Hague. SLUPECKI, J. [19553
System
logiczny
Operators:),
bez
operatorAw
Cl.ogical
S t u d i a Uogica, Vol.III, pp.98-124.
SfcUPECKX, J., HAbKOWSKA, K., PIROQ-RZEPEGKA, K. [19783
Logika
i
teoria
mnogoiSci
(Logic
and
Set
Theory),
Warszawa. STANOSZ, B., NOWACZYK, A. [19763
Logiczne
podstawy
I^anguage),
J^zyka
CThe Logical
Foundations
of
Wrociaw-Warszawa.
SUSZKO, R. [19583
Syntac
tic
Struc
ture
and
Semantical
Reference,
Part
1,
S t u d i a Logica, Vol.VIII, pp.213-44. [19603
Syntactic
Struc
ture
and
Semantical
S t u d i a Logica, Vol.IX, pp.63-93.
Reference,
Part
II,
246 [1964]
REFERENCES O kat^gorioLch. j^zykach
syntaktycznych
sformal
Denotation
of
izowanych.
denotacjach
CSyntac
Expressions
Rozpravry L o g i c z n e , of
i
in
t ic
uryra^eft
Categories
Formalized
w and
Languagesy,
Logical D i s s e r t . a t . i o n s
Ct.o t h e
in:
memory
Kazlmierz AJdukiewicz>, Warszawa, pp.193-204.
TARSKI, A. [1933]
The
Concept
of
Truth
in
Formalized
Languages,
in:
[19563 Cfirst, pubUshed in Polish in 1933>. [19561
L o g i c , S e m a n t . l c s , Met.ainat.heineit.ics. P a p e r s from 1923 t.o 1938,
Oxford .
VAN BENTHEM, J. [19841
The
Logic
of
Semantics,
(eds.), Varlet.es of [19861
in:
Landmam
F.,
Formal Seinant.ics, F o r i s ,
Velt-man
F.
Dordrecht,.
E s s a y s i n Logical Semant-lcs, D.Reidel, Dordrecht..
VANDERVEKEN, D. R. [19761
The and
Leinievtski-Cvtrry the
Theory
Categorially
of
Open
Syntac
Functors,
tical
Categories
Sludia
Logica,
Vol.XXXV, No.2, pp.191-201. WYBRANIEC SKARDOWSKA, U. [1981a]
On the of
Theory
Logic,
of
Labe I-Tokens,
Polish
Academy
Bulletin of of
Sciences,
t-he
Section
Vol.10,
No.l,
pp.30-4. [1981b]
Formaliseacja
teorii
kategorialnych Syntactically 27th
CA
Formalization
Categorial
Conference
October
j^eykdw
on
Languages), the
16-18, 1981, pp.21-6.
History
syntaktycznie of
the
Theory
Proceedings of
Logic,
of
of the
Cracow,
REFERENCES
[1983a]
247
O teorii
napisAw
Tokens:),
egzemplarzy
Publications
of
COn the
the
Opole
Th&ory
of
Engineering
Label College,
M a t h e m a t i c s S e r i e s , No.4, pp.121-5. [1983b]
O istocie COn
i
the
semantycznych
Essence
Namesy,
wloLsnoiciach.
imion
and
Semantic
Proper
ties
Onomastica,
Polish
Academy
wlasnych of
Proper
of
Sciences
Vol.XXVIII, pp.298-310. [1986]
On
the
Type-Token
Section
of
Relationships,
Logic,
Polish
Bulletin
Academy
of
of
the
Sciences,
Vol.15,
No.4, pp.164-71. [1988]
Logiczne
podstaxay
Foundations
of
Filozoficzne,
ontologii
shtadni
Language Loglka
Syntax
a
J^gyka
CLogical
Ontology^,
Studla
No.6-7
C271-272>,
Fllozofia,
pp.264-84. [1989]
On
the
Eliminatibility
of
Ideal
Linguistic
Enti
ties,
napisdw
COn
S t u d i a L o g i c a , Vol.XLVIII, No.4, pp.587-615. [1990]
O dxMich podej^c Two
Approaches
Label sy.
iach to
do the
Publications
for-malizacji
teorii
Formalization
of
of
the
Opole
the
Teachers'
Theory
of
Training
C o l l e g e P r e s s , M a t h e m a t i c s S e r i e s , Vol.XXVII, p p . 3 3 - 4 8 .
Nijhoff International Philosophy Series 1. N. Rotenstreich: Philosophy, History and Politics. Studies in Contemporary English Philosophy of History. 1976 ISBN Pb 90-247-1743-4 2. J.TJ.
STUSAIUCVX:
Elements of Social and Political Philosophy. 1976 ISBN Pb 90-247-1744-2
3. W. Tatariciewicz: Analysis of Happiness. Translated from Polish by E. Rothert and D. Zielirfski. 1976 ISBN 90-247-1807-4 4. K. Twardowski: On the Content and Object of Presentations. A Psychological Investigation. Translated from Polish with an Introduction by R. Grossmann. 1977 ISBN Pb 90-247-1926-7 5. W. Tatarkiewicz: A History of Six Ideas. An Essay in Aesthetics. Translated from Polish a.o. by C. Kasparek. 1980 ISBN 90-247-2233-0 6. H.W. Noonan: Objects and Identity. An Examination of the Relative Identity Thesis and Its Consequences. 1980 ISBN 90-247-2292-6 7. L. Crocker: Positive Liberty. An Essay in Normative Political Philosophy. 1980 ISBN 90-247-2291-8 8. F. Brentano: The Theory of Categories. Translated from German by R.M. Chisholm and N. Guterman. 1981 ISBN 90-247-2302-7 9. W. Marciszewski (ed.): Dictionary of Logic as Applied in the Study of Language. Concepts - Methods - Theories. 1981 ISBN 90-247-2123-7 10. I. Ruzsa: Modal Logic with Descriptions. 1981
ISBN 90-247-2473-2
11. P. Hoffhian: The Anatomy of Idealism. Passivity and Activity in Kant, Hegel and Marx. 1982 ISBN 90-247-2708-1 12. M. S. Gram: Direct Realism. A Study of Perception. 1983 ISBN 90-247-2870-3 13. J.T.J. Srzednicki, V.F. Rickey and J. Czelakowski (eds.): Le^niewski's Systems. Ontology and Mereology. 1984 ISBN 90-247-2879-7 For 'The Le^niewski Collection' see also Volume 24. 14. J. W. Smith: Reductionism and Cultural Being. A Philosophical Critique of Sociobiological Reductionism and Physicalist Scientific Unificationism. 1984 ISBN 90-247-2884-3 15. C. Zumbach: The Transcendent Science. Kant's Conception of Biological Methodology. 1984 ISBN 90-247-2904-1 16. M. A. Nottumo: Objectivity, Rationality and the Third Realm: Justification and the Grounds of Psychologism. A Study of Frege and Popper. 1985 ISBN 90-247-2956-4 Volumes 1-8 previously published under the Series Title: Melbourne International Philosophy Series.
Nijhoff International Philosophy Series 17. i. Dilman (ed.): Philosophy and Life. Essays on John Wisdom. 1984 ISBN 90-247-2996-3 18. J. J. Russell: Analysis and Dialectic. Studies in the Logic of Foundation Problems. 1984 ISBN 90-247-2990-4 19. G. Carrie and A. Musgrave (eds.): Popper and the Human Sciences. 1985 ISBN Hb 90-247-2998-X; Pb 90-247-3141-0 20. C. D. Broad: Ethics. Lectures given at Cambridge during the Period 1933-34 to 1952-53. Edited by C. Lewy. 1985 ISBN 90-247-3088-0 21. D.A.J. Seargent: Plurality and Continuity. An Essay in G.F. Stout's Theory of Universals. 1985 ISBN 90-247-3185-2 22. J.E. Atwell: Ends and Principles in Kant's Moral Thought. 1986 ISBN 90-247-3167-4 23. J. Agassi, and I.C. Jarvie (eds.): Rationality: The Critical View. 1987 ISBN Hb 90-247-3275-1; Pb 90-247-3455-X 24. J.T.J. Srzednicki and Z. Stachniak: S. Le^niewski's Lecture Notes in Logic. 1988 ISBN 90-247-3416-9 For 'The Le^niewski's Collection' see also Volume 13. 25. B.M. Taylor (ed.): Michael Dummett. Contributions to Philosophy. 1987 ISBN 90-247-3463-0 26. A. Z. Bar-On: The Categories and the Principle of Coherence. Whitehead's Theory of Categories in Historical Perspective. 1987 ISBN 90-247-3478-9 27. B. Dziemidok and P. McCormick (eds.): On the Aesthetics of Roman Ingarden. Interpretations and Assessments. 1989 ISBN 0-7923-0071 -8 28. J.T.J. Srzednicki (ed.): Stephan Korner - Philosophical Analysis and Reconstruction. Contributions to Philosophy. 1987 ISBN 90-247-3543-2 29. F. Brentano: On the Existence of God. Lectures given at the Universities of Wurzburg and Vienna (1868-1891). Edited and translated from German by Susan F. Krantz. 1987 ISBN 90-247-3538-6 30. Z. Augustynek: Time. Past, Present and Future. Essays dedicated to Henryk Mehlberg. (in preparation) ISBN 0-7923-0270-2 31. T.Paw\owskv. AesthetiQ Values. 19^9
ISBN 0-7923-0418-7
32. M. Ruse (ed.): What the Philosophy of Biology Is. Essays dedicated to David Hull. 1989 ISBN 90-247-3778-8 33. J. Young: Willing and Unwilling. A Study in the Philosophy of Arthur Schopenhauer. 1987 ISBN 90-247-3556-4 34. T. Z. Lavine and V. Tejera (eds.): History and Anti-History in Philosophy. 1989 ISBN 0-7923-0455-1
Nijhoff International Philosophy Series 35. R.L. Epstein: The Semantic Foundations of Logic. Volume 1: Prepositional Logics. With the assistance and collaboration of W.A. Camielli, I.M.L. D'Ottaviano, S. Krajewski and R.D. Maddux. 1990 ISBN 0-7923-0622-8 36. A. Pavkovic (ed.): Contemporary Yugoslav Philosophy. The Analytic Approach. 1988 ISBN 90-247-3776-1 37. A. Winterboume: The Ideal and the Real. An Outline of Kant's Theory of Space, Time and Mathematical Construction. 1988 ISBN 90-247-3774-5 38. K. Szaniawski (ed.): 77i^ Vienna Circle and the Lvov-Warsaw School. 1989 ISBN 90-247-3798-2 39. G. Priest: In Contradiction. A Study of the Transconsistent. 1987 ISBN 90-247-3630-7 40. J. Wolenski (ed.): Kotarhinski: Logic, Semantics and Ontology. 1990 ISBN 0-7923-0865-4 41. P. Geach (ed.): Logic and Ethics. 1991
ISBN 0-7923-1044-6
42. U. Wybraniec-Skardowska: Theory of Language Syntax. Categorial Approach. 1991. ISBN 0-7923-1142-6
Further information about our publications on Philosophy are available on request. Kluwer Academic Publishers - Dordrecht / Boston / London